Merge branch 'gtk-im-modules'
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 090B11993D9AEBB5
14
15 @copying
16 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
17 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
18 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
19 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
20 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
21 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
22 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
23 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari@*
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Ricardo Wurmus@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Chris Marusich@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Efraim Flashner@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 ng0
29
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end copying
37
38 @dircategory System administration
39 @direntry
40 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
41 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
42 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
43 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
44 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
45 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
46 @end direntry
47
48 @dircategory Software development
49 @direntry
50 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
51 @end direntry
52
53 @dircategory Emacs
54 @direntry
55 * Guix user interface: (guix)Emacs Interface. Package management from the comfort of Emacs.
56 @end direntry
57
58
59 @titlepage
60 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
61 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
62 @author The GNU Guix Developers
63
64 @page
65 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
66 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
67 @value{UPDATED} @*
68
69 @insertcopying
70 @end titlepage
71
72 @contents
73
74 @c *********************************************************************
75 @node Top
76 @top GNU Guix
77
78 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
79 package management tool written for the GNU system.
80
81 @menu
82 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
83 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
84 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
85 * Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
86 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
87 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
88 * GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
89 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
90
91 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
92 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
93 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
94 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
95
96 @detailmenu
97 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
98
99 Installation
100
101 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
102 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
103 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
104 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
105 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
106 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
107
108 Setting Up the Daemon
109
110 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
111 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
112
113 Package Management
114
115 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
116 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
117 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
118 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
119 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
120 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
121 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
122
123 Emacs Interface
124
125 * Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
126 * Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
127 * Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
128 * Package Source Locations: Emacs Package Locations. Interface for package location files.
129 * Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
130 * Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
131 * Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
132 * Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
133 * Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
134 * Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
135
136 Programming Interface
137
138 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
139 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
140 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
141 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
142 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
143 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
144
145 Defining Packages
146
147 * package Reference:: The package data type.
148 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
149
150 Utilities
151
152 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
153 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
154 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
155 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
156 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
157 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
158 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
159 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
160 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
161 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
162 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
163 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
164 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
165
166 Invoking @command{guix build}
167
168 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
169 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
170 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
171
172 GNU Distribution
173
174 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
175 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
176 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
177 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
178 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
179 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
180 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
181 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
182
183 System Installation
184
185 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
186 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
187 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
188 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
189 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
190 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
191 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
192
193 System Configuration
194
195 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
196 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
197 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
198 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
199 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
200 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
201 * Services:: Specifying system services.
202 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
203 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
204 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
205 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
206 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
207 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
208 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
209 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
210
211 Services
212
213 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
214 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
215 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
216 * X Window:: Graphical display.
217 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
218 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
219 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
220 * Web Services:: Web servers.
221 * Various Services:: Other services.
222
223 Defining Services
224
225 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
226 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
227 * Service Reference:: API reference.
228 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
229
230 Packaging Guidelines
231
232 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
233 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
234 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
235 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
236 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
237 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
238 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
239 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
240
241 Contributing
242
243 * Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
244 * Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
245 * The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
246 * Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
247 * Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
248
249 Coding Style
250
251 * Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
252 * Modules:: Where to store your code?
253 * Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
254 * Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
255
256 @end detailmenu
257 @end menu
258
259 @c *********************************************************************
260 @node Introduction
261 @chapter Introduction
262
263 @cindex purpose
264 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
265 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
266 management tool for the GNU system. Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
267 users to install, upgrade, or remove packages, to roll back to a
268 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
269 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
270
271 @cindex user interfaces
272 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
273 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}), a set of command-line utilities
274 (@pxref{Utilities}), a visual user interface in Emacs (@pxref{Emacs
275 Interface}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
276 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
277 @cindex build daemon
278 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
279 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
280 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
281
282 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
283 @cindex customization of packages
284 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
285 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
286 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
287 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
288 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
289 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
290 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
291 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
292
293 @cindex Guix System Distribution
294 @cindex GuixSD
295 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system
296 where it complements the available tools without interference
297 (@pxref{Installation}), or you can use it as part of the standalone
298 @dfn{Guix System Distribution} or GuixSD (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
299 With GNU@tie{}GuixSD, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating
300 system configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the
301 configuration in a transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion
302 (@pxref{System Configuration}).
303
304 @cindex functional package management
305 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
306 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
307 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
308 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
309 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
310 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
311 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
312 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
313 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
314 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
315 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
316 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
317 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
318 explicit inputs are visible.
319
320 @cindex store
321 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
322 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
323 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
324 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
325 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
326 input yields a different directory name.
327
328 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
329 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
330 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
331
332
333 @c *********************************************************************
334 @node Installation
335 @chapter Installation
336
337 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
338 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
339 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
340 ready to use it.
341
342 Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
343 manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
344 instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
345 @pxref{System Installation}.
346
347 @cindex foreign distro
348 When installed on a running GNU/Linux system---thereafter called a
349 @dfn{foreign distro}---GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available tools
350 without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
351 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your
352 system, such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
353
354 @menu
355 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
356 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
357 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
358 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
359 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
360 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
361 @end menu
362
363 @node Binary Installation
364 @section Binary Installation
365
366 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
367 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
368 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
369 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
370 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
371
372 Installing goes along these lines:
373
374 @enumerate
375 @item
376 Download the binary tarball from
377 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
378 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
379 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
380
381 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
382 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
383 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
384
385 @example
386 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
387 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
388 @end example
389
390 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
391 then run this command to import it:
392
393 @example
394 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
395 @end example
396
397 @noindent
398 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
399 @c end authentication part
400
401 @item
402 As @code{root}, run:
403
404 @example
405 # cd /tmp
406 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
407 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
408 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
409 @end example
410
411 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
412 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
413 step.)
414
415 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
416 would overwrite its own essential files.
417
418 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
419 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
420 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
421 versions are fine.)
422 They stem from the fact that all the
423 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
424 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
425 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
426 reproducible.
427
428 @item
429 Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
430
431 @example
432 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
433 ~root/.guix-profile
434 @end example
435
436 @item
437 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
438 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
439
440 @item
441 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
442
443 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
444 with these commands:
445
446 @example
447 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
448 /etc/systemd/system/
449 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
450 @end example
451
452 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
453
454 @example
455 # cp ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf /etc/init/
456 # start guix-daemon
457 @end example
458
459 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
460
461 @example
462 # ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
463 @end example
464
465 @item
466 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
467 for instance with:
468
469 @example
470 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
471 # cd /usr/local/bin
472 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
473 @end example
474
475 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
476 there:
477
478 @example
479 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
480 # cd /usr/local/share/info
481 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
482 do ln -s $i ; done
483 @end example
484
485 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
486 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
487 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
488 Info search path.)
489
490 @item
491 To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or one of its mirrors
492 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
493
494 @example
495 # guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
496 @end example
497 @end enumerate
498
499 This completes root-level install of Guix. Each user will need to
500 perform additional steps to make their Guix environment ready for use,
501 @pxref{Application Setup}.
502
503 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
504 the root profile:
505
506 @example
507 # guix package -i hello
508 @end example
509
510 The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s profile,
511 or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which case you
512 would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the @command{guix}
513 command. In other words, do not remove @code{guix} by running
514 @code{guix package -r guix}.
515
516 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
517 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
518
519 @example
520 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
521 @end example
522
523
524 @node Requirements
525 @section Requirements
526
527 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
528 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
529 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
530 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
531
532 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
533
534 @itemize
535 @item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
536 @item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
537 @item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
538 @end itemize
539
540 The following dependencies are optional:
541
542 @itemize
543 @item
544 Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will allow you to
545 access @code{https} URLs for substitutes, which is highly recommended
546 (@pxref{Substitutes}). It also allows you to access HTTPS URLs with the
547 @command{guix download} command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the
548 @command{guix import pypi} command, and the @command{guix import cpan}
549 command. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings
550 for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
551
552 @item
553 Installing
554 @url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
555 allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
556 guix import}). It is of
557 interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
558
559 @item
560 When @url{http://zlib.net, zlib} is available, @command{guix publish}
561 can compress build byproducts (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
562 @end itemize
563
564 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
565 following packages are also needed:
566
567 @itemize
568 @item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
569 @item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
570 @item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
571 C++11 standard.
572 @end itemize
573
574 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
575 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
576 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
577 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
578 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
579 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
580 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
581
582 When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
583 manager} is available, you
584 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
585 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
586
587 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
588 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
589 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
590 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
591 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
592 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
593 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
594 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
595 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
596
597 @node Running the Test Suite
598 @section Running the Test Suite
599
600 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
601 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
602 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
603 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
604 suite, type:
605
606 @example
607 make check
608 @end example
609
610 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
611 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
612 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
613 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
614 cache.
615
616 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
617 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
618
619 @example
620 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
621 @end example
622
623 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
624 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
625 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
626
627 @example
628 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
629 @end example
630
631 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
632 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
633 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
634 your message.
635
636 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
637 GuixSD operating system instances. It can only run on systems where
638 Guix is already installed, using:
639
640 @example
641 make check-system
642 @end example
643
644 @noindent
645 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
646
647 @example
648 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
649 @end example
650
651 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
652 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
653 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
654 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
655 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
656 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
657
658 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
659 all the details.
660
661 @node Setting Up the Daemon
662 @section Setting Up the Daemon
663
664 @cindex daemon
665 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
666 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
667 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
668 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
669 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
670 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
671 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
672
673 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
674 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
675 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
676
677 @menu
678 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
679 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
680 @end menu
681
682 @node Build Environment Setup
683 @subsection Build Environment Setup
684
685 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
686 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
687 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
688 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
689 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
690 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
691 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
692
693 @cindex build users
694 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
695 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
696 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
697 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
698 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
699 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
700 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
701 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
702 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
703 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
704
705 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
706 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
707
708 @c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
709 @c for why `-G' is needed.
710 @example
711 # groupadd --system guixbuild
712 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
713 do
714 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
715 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
716 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
717 guixbuilder$i;
718 done
719 @end example
720
721 @noindent
722 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
723 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
724 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
725 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
726 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
727 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
728 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
729
730 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
731 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
732 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
733 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
734 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
735 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
736 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
737 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
738
739 @example
740 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
741 @end example
742
743 @cindex chroot
744 @noindent
745 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
746 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
747 environment contains nothing but:
748
749 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
750 @itemize
751 @item
752 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
753 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
754 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
755 can only be created if the host has them.};
756
757 @item
758 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
759 since a separate PID name space is used;
760
761 @item
762 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
763 user @file{nobody};
764
765 @item
766 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
767
768 @item
769 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
770 @code{127.0.0.1};
771
772 @item
773 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
774 @end itemize
775
776 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
777 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
778 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
779 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
780 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
781 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
782 capture the name of their build tree.
783
784 @vindex http_proxy
785 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
786 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
787 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
788
789 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
790 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
791 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
792 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
793 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
794 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
795 @emph{pure} functions.
796
797
798 @node Daemon Offload Setup
799 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
800
801 @cindex offloading
802 @cindex build hook
803 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
804 derivation builds to other machines
805 running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
806 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
807 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
808 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
809 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
810 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
811 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
812 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
813 build are copied back to the initial machine.
814
815 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
816
817 @example
818 (list (build-machine
819 (name "eightysix.example.org")
820 (system "x86_64-linux")
821 (user "bob")
822 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
823
824 (build-machine
825 (name "meeps.example.org")
826 (system "mips64el-linux")
827 (user "alice")
828 (private-key
829 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
830 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
831 @end example
832
833 @noindent
834 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
835 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
836 architecture.
837
838 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
839 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
840 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
841 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
842 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
843 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
844 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
845 detailed below.
846
847 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
848 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
849 builds. The important fields are:
850
851 @table @code
852
853 @item name
854 The host name of the remote machine.
855
856 @item system
857 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
858
859 @item user
860 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
861 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
862 allow non-interactive logins.
863
864 @end table
865
866 A number of optional fields may be specified:
867
868 @table @code
869
870 @item port
871 Port number of SSH server on the machine (default: 22).
872
873 @item private-key
874 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
875
876 Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
877 (@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
878 be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
879
880 @item parallel-builds
881 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
882 default.)
883
884 @item speed
885 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
886 machines with a higher speed factor.
887
888 @item features
889 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
890 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
891 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
892 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
893
894 @end table
895 @end deftp
896
897 The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
898 machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
899 @code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
900 @code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
901 this is the case by running:
902
903 @example
904 lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
905 @end example
906
907 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
908 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
909 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
910 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
911 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
912
913 @example
914 # guix archive --generate-key
915 @end example
916
917 @noindent
918 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
919 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
920
921 @example
922 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
923 @end example
924
925 @noindent
926 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
927
928 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
929 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
930 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
931 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
932 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
933
934
935 @node Invoking guix-daemon
936 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
937
938 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
939 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
940 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
941 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
942
943 @example
944 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
945 @end example
946
947 @noindent
948 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
949
950 @cindex chroot
951 @cindex container, build environment
952 @cindex build environment
953 @cindex reproducible builds
954 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
955 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
956 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
957 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
958 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
959 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
960 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
961 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
962 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
963 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
964 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
965
966 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
967 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
968 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
969 the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
970 directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
971 with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
972 sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
973 it would otherwise not hit.
974
975 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
976 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
977 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
978
979 The following command-line options are supported:
980
981 @table @code
982 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
983 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
984 the Daemon, build users}).
985
986 @item --no-substitutes
987 @cindex substitutes
988 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
989 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
990 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
991
992 By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
993 @command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
994 @code{--no-substitutes}.
995
996 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
997 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
998 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
999
1000 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1001 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1002 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1003 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1004 @indicateurl{https://mirror.hydra.gnu.org https://hydra.gnu.org} is used
1005 (@code{mirror.hydra.gnu.org} is a mirror of @code{hydra.gnu.org}).
1006
1007 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1008 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1009
1010 @cindex build hook
1011 @item --no-build-hook
1012 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1013
1014 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1015 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1016 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1017
1018 @item --cache-failures
1019 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1020
1021 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1022 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1023 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1024 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1025
1026 @item --cores=@var{n}
1027 @itemx -c @var{n}
1028 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1029 as available.
1030
1031 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1032 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1033 guix build}).
1034
1035 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1036 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1037 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1038
1039 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1040 @itemx -M @var{n}
1041 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1042 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1043 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1044 Setup}), or simply fail.
1045
1046 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1047 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1048 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1049 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1050 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1051
1052 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1053 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1054 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1055
1056 @item --debug
1057 Produce debugging output.
1058
1059 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1060 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1061 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1062
1063 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1064 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1065
1066 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1067 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1068 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1069 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1070 needs.
1071
1072 @item --disable-chroot
1073 Disable chroot builds.
1074
1075 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1076 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1077 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1078 account.
1079
1080 @item --disable-log-compression
1081 Disable compression of the build logs.
1082
1083 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1084 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1085 them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
1086
1087 @item --disable-deduplication
1088 @cindex deduplication
1089 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1090
1091 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1092 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1093 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1094 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1095 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1096 this optimization.
1097
1098 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1099 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1100 derivations.
1101
1102 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1103 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1104 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
1105
1106 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1107 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1108 corresponding to live outputs.
1109
1110 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1111 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1112 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1113 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1114
1115 Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
1116 @code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
1117 prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
1118 tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
1119 prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
1120 saves rebuilds or downloads.
1121
1122 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1123 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1124 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1125
1126 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1127 on the kernel version number.
1128
1129 @item --lose-logs
1130 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1131 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1132
1133 @item --system=@var{system}
1134 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1135 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1136 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1137
1138 @item --listen=@var{socket}
1139 Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1140 socket. The default socket is
1141 @file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1142 useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1143 daemons on the same machine.
1144 @end table
1145
1146
1147 @node Application Setup
1148 @section Application Setup
1149
1150 @cindex foreign distro
1151 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1152 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1153 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1154
1155 @subsection Locales
1156
1157 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1158 @cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
1159 @vindex LOCPATH
1160 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1161 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1162 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1163 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1164 variable:
1165
1166 @example
1167 $ guix package -i glibc-locales
1168 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1169 @end example
1170
1171 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1172 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1173 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1174 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1175
1176 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1177 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1178 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1179
1180 @enumerate
1181 @item
1182 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1183 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1184 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1185 incompatible locale data.
1186
1187 @item
1188 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1189 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1190 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1191 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1192 data in the right format.
1193 @end enumerate
1194
1195 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1196 versions may be incompatible.
1197
1198 @subsection X11 Fonts
1199
1200 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1201 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1202 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1203 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1204 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1205 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1206 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1207
1208 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1209 graphical applications, consider installing
1210 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1211 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1212 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1213 for Chinese languages:
1214
1215 @example
1216 guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1217 @end example
1218
1219 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1220 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1221 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1222
1223 @example
1224 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1225 @end example
1226
1227 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1228 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1229
1230 @example
1231 xset +fp ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype
1232 @end example
1233
1234 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1235 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1236
1237 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1238
1239 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1240 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1241
1242 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1243 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1244 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1245 information.
1246
1247 @subsection Emacs Packages
1248
1249 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1250 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1251 sub-directories of
1252 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1253 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1254 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1255 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1256 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1257 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1258 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1259
1260 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1261 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1262 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1263 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1264 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1265
1266 @c TODO What else?
1267
1268 @c *********************************************************************
1269 @node Package Management
1270 @chapter Package Management
1271
1272 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
1273 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
1274 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
1275 features.
1276
1277 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
1278 management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
1279 routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1280 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1281 interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
1282
1283 @menu
1284 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
1285 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
1286 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
1287 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
1288 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
1289 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
1290 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
1291 @end menu
1292
1293 @node Features
1294 @section Features
1295
1296 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1297 own directory---something that resembles
1298 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1299 (note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
1300 names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
1301
1302 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1303 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
1304 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1305 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
1306
1307 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
1308 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
1309 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
1310 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1311 simply continues to point to
1312 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
1313 coexist on the same system without any interference.
1314
1315 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
1316 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
1317 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
1318
1319 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1320 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
1321 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
1322 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
1323 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1324 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1325
1326 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1327 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1328 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
1329 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1330 system configuration on GuixSD is subject to
1331 transactional upgrades and roll-back
1332 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
1333
1334 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1335 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
1336 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
1337 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
1338 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1339 collected.
1340
1341 @cindex reproducibility
1342 @cindex reproducible builds
1343 Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1344 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
1345 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
1346 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1347 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1348 given package installation matches the current state of their
1349 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1350 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1351 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1352 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
1353
1354 @cindex substitutes
1355 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
1356 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
1357 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
1358 downloads it and unpacks it;
1359 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1360 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
1361 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
1362 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
1363 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
1364
1365 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1366 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1367 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
1368 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1369 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1370
1371 @node Invoking guix package
1372 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
1373
1374 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
1375 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1376 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1377 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1378 is:
1379
1380 @example
1381 guix package @var{options}
1382 @end example
1383
1384 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
1385 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
1386 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
1387 want to roll back.
1388
1389 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1390 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1391
1392 @example
1393 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1394 @end example
1395
1396 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1397 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1398 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1399 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1400
1401 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
1402 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
1403 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1404 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1405 variable, and so on.
1406 @cindex search paths
1407 If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1408 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1409 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1410 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1411
1412 @example
1413 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1414 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1415 @end example
1416
1417 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1418 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1419 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
1420 @code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1421 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
1422 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1423 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1424 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1425 package}.
1426
1427 The @var{options} can be among the following:
1428
1429 @table @code
1430
1431 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1432 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1433 Install the specified @var{package}s.
1434
1435 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
1436 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
1437 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
1438 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1439
1440 If no version number is specified, the
1441 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1442 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
1443 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
1444 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1445 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1446 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
1447
1448 @cindex propagated inputs
1449 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
1450 that automatically get installed along with the required package
1451 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1452 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1453 package definitions).
1454
1455 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
1456 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1457 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1458 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1459 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
1460 also been explicitly installed by the user.
1461
1462 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
1463 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
1464 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
1465 environment variable definitions are reported here.
1466
1467 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1468 @itemx -e @var{exp}
1469 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1470
1471 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1472 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1473 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1474 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1475
1476 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1477 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1478 multiple-output package.
1479
1480 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1481 @itemx -f @var{file}
1482 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1483
1484 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1485 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1486
1487 @example
1488 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1489 @end example
1490
1491 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
1492 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
1493 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1494 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1495
1496 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1497 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1498 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
1499
1500 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
1501 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1502 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1503 @code{glibc}.
1504
1505 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1506 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1507 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1508 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
1509 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
1510
1511 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1512 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1513 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1514 pull}).
1515
1516 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1517 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1518 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1519 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1520 substring ``emacs'':
1521
1522 @example
1523 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1524 @end example
1525
1526 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1527 @itemx -m @var{file}
1528 @cindex profile declaration
1529 @cindex profile manifest
1530 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1531 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1532
1533 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1534 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1535 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1536 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1537 so on.
1538
1539 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1540 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1541 of packages:
1542
1543 @findex packages->manifest
1544 @example
1545 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
1546
1547 (packages->manifest
1548 (list emacs
1549 guile-2.0
1550 ;; Use a specific package output.
1551 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1552 @end example
1553
1554 @item --roll-back
1555 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1556 the last transaction.
1557
1558 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1559 before any other actions.
1560
1561 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
1562 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
1563 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
1564
1565 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1566 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1567 generations in a profile is always linear.
1568
1569 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1570 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
1571 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1572
1573 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1574 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1575 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1576 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1577 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1578
1579 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1580 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1581 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1582 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1583
1584 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
1585 @cindex search paths
1586 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1587 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1588 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1589 of the installed packages.
1590
1591 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1592 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1593 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1594 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1595 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1596 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1597 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1598
1599 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1600 shell:
1601
1602 @example
1603 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1604 @end example
1605
1606 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1607 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1608 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1609 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1610
1611 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1612 of several profiles. Consider this example:
1613
1614 @example
1615 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
1616 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1617 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1618 @end example
1619
1620 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1621 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1622 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1623
1624
1625 @item --profile=@var{profile}
1626 @itemx -p @var{profile}
1627 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1628
1629 @item --verbose
1630 Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
1631 environment on the standard error port.
1632
1633 @item --bootstrap
1634 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1635 useful to distribution developers.
1636
1637 @end table
1638
1639 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
1640 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1641 availability of packages:
1642
1643 @table @option
1644
1645 @item --search=@var{regexp}
1646 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
1647 @cindex searching for packages
1648 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
1649 @var{regexp}. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
1650 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1651 GNU recutils manual}).
1652
1653 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1654 command, for instance:
1655
1656 @example
1657 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
1658 name: glibc
1659 version: 2.17
1660
1661 name: libgc
1662 version: 7.2alpha6
1663 @end example
1664
1665 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1666 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1667
1668 @example
1669 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1670 name: elfutils
1671
1672 name: gmp
1673 @dots{}
1674 @end example
1675
1676 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1677 flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1678 games:
1679
1680 @example
1681 $ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1682 name: gnubg
1683 @dots{}
1684 @end example
1685
1686 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1687 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1688 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1689 keyboards.
1690
1691 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1692 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1693 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1694
1695 @example
1696 $ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1697 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1698 @end example
1699
1700 @noindent
1701 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1702 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1703
1704 @item --show=@var{package}
1705 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1706 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1707 recutils manual}).
1708
1709 @example
1710 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1711 name: python
1712 version: 2.7.6
1713
1714 name: python
1715 version: 3.3.5
1716 @end example
1717
1718 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1719 specific version of it:
1720 @example
1721 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
1722 name: python
1723 version: 3.4.3
1724 @end example
1725
1726
1727
1728 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1729 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
1730 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1731 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1732 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1733
1734 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1735 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1736 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1737 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1738 the store.
1739
1740 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1741 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
1742 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
1743 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1744 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
1745
1746 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
1747 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1748 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
1749
1750 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1751 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1752 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1753 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
1754 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1755 shown.
1756
1757 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1758 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1759 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1760 location of this package in the store.
1761
1762 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1763 generations. Valid patterns include:
1764
1765 @itemize
1766 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1767 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1768 the first one.
1769
1770 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1771 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1772
1773 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1774 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
1775 a range must be smaller than its end.
1776
1777 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1778 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1779 second one.
1780
1781 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1782 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
1783 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1784 that are up to 20 days old.
1785 @end itemize
1786
1787 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1788 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
1789 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1790 one.
1791
1792 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
1793 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1794 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1795 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1796 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1797
1798 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1799 zeroth generation is never deleted.
1800
1801 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
1802 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1803
1804 @end table
1805
1806 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
1807 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
1808 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
1809 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1810 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
1811 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
1812 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1813 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1814
1815
1816 @node Substitutes
1817 @section Substitutes
1818
1819 @cindex substitutes
1820 @cindex pre-built binaries
1821 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1822 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1823 server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1824 substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1825 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1826
1827 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1828 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1829 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1830 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1831
1832 The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1833 builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
1834 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1835 Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1836 server). This is the
1837 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1838 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1839 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1840 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1841 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1842 option}).
1843
1844 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS@footnote{For HTTPS access,
1845 the Guile bindings of GnuTLS must be installed. @xref{Requirements}.}
1846 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
1847 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
1848 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
1849 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
1850
1851 @cindex security
1852 @cindex digital signatures
1853 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} or a
1854 mirror thereof, you
1855 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1856 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1857 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1858 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1859
1860 This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1861 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1862 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1863 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1864 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1865 Then, you can run something like this:
1866
1867 @example
1868 # guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1869 @end example
1870
1871 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1872 should change from something like:
1873
1874 @example
1875 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
1876 The following derivations would be built:
1877 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1878 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1879 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1880 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1881 @dots{}
1882 @end example
1883
1884 @noindent
1885 to something like:
1886
1887 @example
1888 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
1889 The following files would be downloaded:
1890 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1891 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1892 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1893 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1894 @dots{}
1895 @end example
1896
1897 @noindent
1898 This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1899 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1900
1901 Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
1902 one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
1903 when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1904
1905 @vindex http_proxy
1906 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
1907 The @code{http_proxy} environment
1908 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1909 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1910 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1911 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1912 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
1913
1914 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
1915 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
1916 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
1917 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
1918 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
1919 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
1920
1921 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1922 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1923 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1924 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1925 build}, and other command-line tools.
1926
1927
1928 @unnumberedsubsec On Trusting Binaries
1929
1930 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1931 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1932 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1933 weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1934 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1935 their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
1936 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1937 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1938 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
1939
1940 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1941 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1942 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1943 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
1944 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1945 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1946 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
1947 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1948 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1949 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1950 @command{guix build --check}}).
1951
1952 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1953 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1954 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1955
1956
1957 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1958 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1959
1960 @cindex multiple-output packages
1961 @cindex package outputs
1962
1963 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
1964 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
1965 @command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1966 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1967 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1968 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1969 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1970 files.
1971
1972 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1973 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1974 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1975 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1976 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1977 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1978 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1979
1980 @example
1981 guix package -i glib
1982 @end example
1983
1984 The command to install its documentation is:
1985
1986 @example
1987 guix package -i glib:doc
1988 @end example
1989
1990 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
1991 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
1992 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1993 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1994 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1995 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
1996 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1997 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
1998 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
1999
2000 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
2001 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
2002 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
2003 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
2004 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
2005 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
2006 guix package}).
2007
2008
2009 @node Invoking guix gc
2010 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
2011
2012 @cindex garbage collector
2013 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
2014 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
2015 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
2016 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
2017 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
2018
2019 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
2020 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
2021 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
2022 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
2023 profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
2024 example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
2025
2026 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
2027 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
2028 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
2029 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
2030 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2031
2032 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
2033 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
2034 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
2035 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
2036 options are as follows:
2037
2038 @table @code
2039 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
2040 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
2041 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
2042 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
2043 specified.
2044
2045 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
2046 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
2047 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
2048 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
2049
2050 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
2051
2052 @item --free-space=@var{free}
2053 @itemx -F @var{free}
2054 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
2055 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
2056 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
2057
2058 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
2059 nothing and exit immediately.
2060
2061 @item --delete
2062 @itemx -d
2063 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
2064 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
2065 they are still live.
2066
2067 @item --list-failures
2068 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
2069
2070 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
2071 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
2072 @option{--cache-failures}}).
2073
2074 @item --clear-failures
2075 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
2076
2077 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
2078 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
2079
2080 @item --list-dead
2081 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
2082 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
2083
2084 @item --list-live
2085 Show the list of live store files and directories.
2086
2087 @end table
2088
2089 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
2090
2091 @table @code
2092
2093 @item --references
2094 @itemx --referrers
2095 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
2096 as arguments.
2097
2098 @item --requisites
2099 @itemx -R
2100 @cindex closure
2101 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
2102 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
2103 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
2104 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
2105
2106 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
2107 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
2108 the graph of references.
2109
2110 @end table
2111
2112 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
2113 store and to control disk usage.
2114
2115 @table @option
2116
2117 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
2118 @cindex integrity, of the store
2119 @cindex integrity checking
2120 Verify the integrity of the store.
2121
2122 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
2123 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
2124
2125 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
2126 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
2127
2128 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
2129 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
2130 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
2131 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
2132 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
2133
2134 @cindex repairing the store
2135 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
2136 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
2137 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
2138 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
2139 system administrator.
2140
2141 @item --optimize
2142 @cindex deduplication
2143 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
2144 @dfn{deduplication}.
2145
2146 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
2147 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
2148 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
2149 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
2150 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
2151
2152 @end table
2153
2154 @node Invoking guix pull
2155 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
2156
2157 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
2158 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
2159 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
2160 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
2161 descriptions, and deploys it.
2162
2163 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
2164 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
2165 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
2166 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
2167 become available.
2168
2169 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
2170 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
2171 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
2172 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
2173 versa@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates the
2174 @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest Guix,
2175 and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
2176
2177 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
2178 but it supports the following options:
2179
2180 @table @code
2181 @item --verbose
2182 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
2183
2184 @item --url=@var{url}
2185 Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
2186
2187 By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
2188 @code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
2189
2190 @item --bootstrap
2191 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
2192 useful to Guix developers.
2193 @end table
2194
2195
2196 @node Invoking guix archive
2197 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2198
2199 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2200 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2201 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
2202 to the store on another machine.
2203
2204 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
2205
2206 @example
2207 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2208 @end example
2209
2210 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2211 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2212 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2213 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2214 output of @code{emacs}:
2215
2216 @example
2217 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
2218 @end example
2219
2220 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2221 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
2222 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
2223
2224 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
2225 one would run:
2226
2227 @example
2228 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
2229 @end example
2230
2231 @noindent
2232 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2233 to another like this:
2234
2235 @example
2236 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2237 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2238 @end example
2239
2240 @noindent
2241 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2242 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
2243 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2244 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2245 items are missing from the target store.
2246
2247 Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
2248 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2249 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
2250 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the Nar format only mentions
2251 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2252 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2253 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2254 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2255 deterministic.
2256
2257 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2258 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2259 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2260 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
2261 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2262
2263 The main options are:
2264
2265 @table @code
2266 @item --export
2267 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2268 resulting archive to the standard output.
2269
2270 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2271 @code{--recursive} is passed.
2272
2273 @item -r
2274 @itemx --recursive
2275 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2276 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2277 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2278 of the exported store items.
2279
2280 @item --import
2281 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2282 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
2283 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2284 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
2285
2286 @item --missing
2287 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2288 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2289 the store.
2290
2291 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
2292 @cindex signing, archives
2293 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
2294 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2295 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2296 generate the key pair.
2297
2298 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2299 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
2300 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2301 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2302 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
2303 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
2304 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2305 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2306 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
2307
2308 @item --authorize
2309 @cindex authorizing, archives
2310 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2311 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2312 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2313
2314 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2315 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2316 @url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2317 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2318 @url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2319 (SPKI)}.
2320
2321 @item --extract=@var{directory}
2322 @itemx -x @var{directory}
2323 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2324 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2325 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2326
2327 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2328 served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2329
2330 @example
2331 $ wget -O - \
2332 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2333 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2334 @end example
2335
2336 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2337 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2338 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2339 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2340 unsafe.
2341
2342 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2343 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2344
2345 @end table
2346
2347 @c *********************************************************************
2348 @include emacs.texi
2349
2350 @c *********************************************************************
2351 @node Programming Interface
2352 @chapter Programming Interface
2353
2354 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2355 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2356 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2357 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2358 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2359 turned into concrete build actions.
2360
2361 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
2362 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
2363 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
2364 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2365 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2366
2367 @cindex derivation
2368 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2369 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2370 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2371 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2372 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
2373 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2374 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
2375
2376 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2377 package definitions.
2378
2379 @menu
2380 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
2381 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
2382 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2383 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2384 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
2385 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
2386 @end menu
2387
2388 @node Defining Packages
2389 @section Defining Packages
2390
2391 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2392 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2393 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2394 package looks like this:
2395
2396 @example
2397 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
2398 #:use-module (guix packages)
2399 #:use-module (guix download)
2400 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
2401 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2402 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
2403
2404 (define-public hello
2405 (package
2406 (name "hello")
2407 (version "2.10")
2408 (source (origin
2409 (method url-fetch)
2410 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2411 ".tar.gz"))
2412 (sha256
2413 (base32
2414 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
2415 (build-system gnu-build-system)
2416 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
2417 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
2418 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2419 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
2420 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
2421 (license gpl3+)))
2422 @end example
2423
2424 @noindent
2425 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
2426 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
2427 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
2428 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2429 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2430 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2431 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2432
2433 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2434 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2435 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2436
2437 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
2438 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2439 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2440 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2441 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2442
2443 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2444
2445 @itemize
2446 @item
2447 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2448 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
2449 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2450 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2451
2452 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2453 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2454
2455 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2456 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2457 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
2458 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
2459 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2460 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
2461
2462 @cindex patches
2463 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2464 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2465 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2466
2467 @item
2468 @cindex GNU Build System
2469 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2470 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2471 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2472 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2473 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2474
2475 @item
2476 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2477 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2478 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2479 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
2480
2481 @cindex quote
2482 @cindex quoting
2483 @findex '
2484 @findex quote
2485 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
2486 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
2487 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
2488 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
2489 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
2490 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
2491 Manual}).
2492
2493 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
2494 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
2495 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
2496 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
2497 Reference Manual}).
2498
2499 @item
2500 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2501 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2502 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2503 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2504
2505 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
2506 @findex `
2507 @findex quasiquote
2508 @cindex comma (unquote)
2509 @findex ,
2510 @findex unquote
2511 @findex ,@@
2512 @findex unquote-splicing
2513 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
2514 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
2515 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
2516 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
2517 Reference Manual}).
2518
2519 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2520 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
2521 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
2522
2523 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2524 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2525 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2526 @end itemize
2527
2528 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2529
2530 Once a package definition is in place, the
2531 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
2532 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2533 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2534 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2535 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
2536 more information on how to test package definitions, and
2537 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2538 for style conformance.
2539
2540 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
2541 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2542 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
2543
2544 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2545 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
2546 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
2547 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
2548 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2549
2550 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
2551 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2552 (@pxref{Derivations}).
2553
2554 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2555 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2556 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2557 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2558 (@pxref{The Store}).
2559 @end deffn
2560
2561 @noindent
2562 @cindex cross-compilation
2563 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2564 package for some other system:
2565
2566 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2567 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
2568 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2569 @var{system} to @var{target}.
2570
2571 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2572 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2573 (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2574 Configure and Build System}).
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @cindex package transformations
2578 @cindex input rewriting
2579 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
2580 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
2581 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
2582 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
2583
2584 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
2585 [@var{rewrite-name}]
2586 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
2587 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
2588 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
2589 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
2590 is the replacement.
2591
2592 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
2593 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
2594 @end deffn
2595
2596 @noindent
2597 Consider this example:
2598
2599 @example
2600 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
2601 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
2602 ;; recursively.
2603 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
2604
2605 (define git-with-libressl
2606 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
2607 @end example
2608
2609 @noindent
2610 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
2611 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
2612 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
2613 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
2614 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
2615
2616 @menu
2617 * package Reference :: The package data type.
2618 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2619 @end menu
2620
2621
2622 @node package Reference
2623 @subsection @code{package} Reference
2624
2625 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2626 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2627
2628 @deftp {Data Type} package
2629 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2630
2631 @table @asis
2632 @item @code{name}
2633 The name of the package, as a string.
2634
2635 @item @code{version}
2636 The version of the package, as a string.
2637
2638 @item @code{source}
2639 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
2640 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
2641 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
2642 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
2643 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
2644 @code{local-file}}).
2645
2646 @item @code{build-system}
2647 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2648 Systems}).
2649
2650 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2651 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2652 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2653
2654 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2655 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2656 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2657 @cindex inputs, of packages
2658 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2659 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2660 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2661 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2662 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
2663 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
2664 inputs:
2665
2666 @example
2667 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
2668 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2669 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2670 @end example
2671
2672 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2673 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2674 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2675 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2676 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2677 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2678
2679 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
2680 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
2681 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2682 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2683
2684 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2685 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
2686 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
2687 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
2688 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2689 propagated inputs.)
2690
2691 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2692 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2693 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2694
2695 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
2696 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
2697 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
2698 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2699 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2700 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
2701
2702 @item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2703 This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2704 a native input when cross-compiling.
2705
2706 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2707 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2708 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2709
2710 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2711 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2712 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2713 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2714
2715 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
2716 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
2717 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2718 for details.
2719
2720 @item @code{synopsis}
2721 A one-line description of the package.
2722
2723 @item @code{description}
2724 A more elaborate description of the package.
2725
2726 @item @code{license}
2727 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
2728 or a list of such values.
2729
2730 @item @code{home-page}
2731 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2732
2733 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2734 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2735 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2736
2737 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2738 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2739
2740 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
2741 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
2742 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2743 automatically corrected.
2744 @end table
2745 @end deftp
2746
2747
2748 @node origin Reference
2749 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
2750
2751 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2752 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2753
2754 @deftp {Data Type} origin
2755 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2756
2757 @table @asis
2758 @item @code{uri}
2759 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2760 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2761 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2762 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2763
2764 @item @code{method}
2765 A procedure that handles the URI.
2766
2767 Examples include:
2768
2769 @table @asis
2770 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
2771 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
2772 @code{uri} field;
2773
2774 @vindex git-fetch
2775 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2776 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2777 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2778 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
2779
2780 @example
2781 (git-reference
2782 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2783 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2784 @end example
2785 @end table
2786
2787 @item @code{sha256}
2788 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2789 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2790 base-32 string.
2791
2792 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
2793 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
2794 guix hash}).
2795
2796 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2797 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2798 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2799 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
2800 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
2801 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2802
2803 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2804 A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2805
2806 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2807 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
2808 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
2809 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2810
2811 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2812 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2813 command.
2814
2815 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2816 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2817 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2818 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2819
2820 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2821 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2822 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2823
2824 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2825 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2826 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2827 @end table
2828 @end deftp
2829
2830
2831 @node Build Systems
2832 @section Build Systems
2833
2834 @cindex build system
2835 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2836 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
2837 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
2838 dependencies of that build procedure.
2839
2840 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2841 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2842 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2843
2844 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
2845 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2846 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2847 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2848 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2849 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2850 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2851
2852 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2853 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2854 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2855 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2856 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2857 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2858 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2859
2860 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
2861 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
2862 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2863
2864 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2865 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2866 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2867 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2868
2869 @cindex build phases
2870 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
2871 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2872 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2873 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2874 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2875 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2876
2877 @table @code
2878 @item unpack
2879 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2880 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2881 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2882
2883 @item patch-source-shebangs
2884 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2885 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2886 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2887
2888 @item configure
2889 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2890 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2891 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2892
2893 @item build
2894 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
2895 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
2896 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2897
2898 @item check
2899 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2900 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2901 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2902 check -j}.
2903
2904 @item install
2905 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2906
2907 @item patch-shebangs
2908 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2909
2910 @item strip
2911 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2912 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2913 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2914 @end table
2915
2916 @vindex %standard-phases
2917 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2918 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2919 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2920 procedure implements the actual phase.
2921
2922 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2923 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2924
2925 @example
2926 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
2927 @end example
2928
2929 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
2930 @code{configure} phase.
2931
2932 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2933 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2934 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
2935 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
2936 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
2937 have to mention them.
2938 @end defvr
2939
2940 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2941 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2942 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2943 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2944 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2945
2946 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
2947 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
2948 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
2949 @url{http://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
2950
2951 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
2952 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
2953 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
2954 parameters, respectively.
2955
2956 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
2957 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
2958 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
2959 archive.
2960
2961 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
2962 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
2963 ``jar'' task will be run.
2964
2965 @end defvr
2966
2967 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2968 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2969 implements the build procedure for packages using the
2970 @url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2971
2972 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2973 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2974 parameter.
2975
2976 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2977 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2978 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2979 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2980 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2981 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
2982 @end defvr
2983
2984 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2985 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2986 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2987
2988 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2989 @var{gnu-build-system}:
2990
2991 @table @code
2992 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
2993 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
2994 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
2995 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2996 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2997 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2998 environment variables.
2999
3000 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
3001 process by listing their names in the
3002 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
3003 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
3004 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
3005 GLib and GTK+.
3006
3007 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
3008 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3009 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
3010 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3011 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
3012 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
3013 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
3014 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
3015 @end table
3016
3017 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
3018 @end defvr
3019
3020 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
3021 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
3022 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
3023 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
3024 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
3025
3026 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
3027 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
3028 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
3029
3030 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
3031 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
3032 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
3033 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
3034 interpreter version.
3035 @end defvr
3036
3037 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
3038 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
3039 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
3040 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
3041 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
3042 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
3043 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
3044 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
3045 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
3046 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
3047 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
3048 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
3049
3050 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
3051 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
3052 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
3053
3054 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
3055 @end defvr
3056
3057 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
3058 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
3059 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
3060 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
3061 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
3062 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
3063 are run after installation using the R function
3064 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
3065 @end defvr
3066
3067 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
3068 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
3069 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
3070 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
3071
3072 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
3073 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
3074 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
3075 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
3076 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
3077 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
3078 a traditional source release tarball.
3079
3080 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
3081 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
3082 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
3083 @end defvr
3084
3085 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
3086 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
3087 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
3088 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
3089 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
3090 script.
3091
3092 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
3093 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
3094 @code{#:python} parameter.
3095 @end defvr
3096
3097 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
3098 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
3099 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
3100 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
3101 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
3102 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
3103 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
3104 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
3105 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
3106 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
3107 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
3108 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
3109 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
3110 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
3111
3112 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
3113 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
3114 @end defvr
3115
3116 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
3117 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
3118 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
3119 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
3120
3121 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
3122 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
3123 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
3124 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
3125 package is installed in its own directory under
3126 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
3127 @end defvr
3128
3129 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
3130 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
3131 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
3132 and does not have a notion of build phases.
3133
3134 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
3135 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
3136
3137 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
3138 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
3139 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
3140 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
3141 @end defvr
3142
3143 @node The Store
3144 @section The Store
3145
3146 @cindex store
3147 @cindex store items
3148 @cindex store paths
3149
3150 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
3151 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
3152 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
3153 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
3154 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
3155 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
3156 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
3157 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
3158 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
3159
3160 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
3161 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
3162 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
3163 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
3164
3165 @quotation Note
3166 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
3167 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
3168 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
3169
3170 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
3171 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
3172 accidental modifications.
3173 @end quotation
3174
3175 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
3176 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
3177
3178 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
3179 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
3180 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
3181 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
3182 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
3183
3184 @var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
3185 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
3186 @end deffn
3187
3188 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
3189 Close the connection to @var{server}.
3190 @end deffn
3191
3192 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
3193 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
3194 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
3195 @end defvr
3196
3197 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
3198 argument.
3199
3200 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
3201 @cindex invalid store items
3202 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
3203 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
3204 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
3205 build.)
3206
3207 A @code{&nix-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
3208 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
3209 @end deffn
3210
3211 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3212 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
3213 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
3214 resulting store path.
3215 @end deffn
3216
3217 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
3218 Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
3219 derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
3220 Return @code{#t} on success.
3221 @end deffn
3222
3223 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
3224 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
3225 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
3226 Store Monad}).
3227
3228 @c FIXME
3229 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
3230
3231 @node Derivations
3232 @section Derivations
3233
3234 @cindex derivations
3235 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
3236 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
3237 following pieces of information:
3238
3239 @itemize
3240 @item
3241 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
3242 directory in the store, but may produce more.
3243
3244 @item
3245 The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
3246 files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
3247
3248 @item
3249 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
3250
3251 @item
3252 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
3253 to be passed.
3254
3255 @item
3256 A list of environment variables to be defined.
3257
3258 @end itemize
3259
3260 @cindex derivation path
3261 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
3262 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
3263 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
3264 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
3265 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
3266 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
3267 Store}).
3268
3269 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
3270 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
3271 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
3272 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
3273
3274 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
3275 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3276 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
3277 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
3278 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3279 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
3280 [#:substitutable? #t]
3281 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
3282 @code{<derivation>} object.
3283
3284 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
3285 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
3286 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
3287 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
3288 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
3289 containing this output.
3290
3291 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
3292 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
3293 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
3294 a simple text format.
3295
3296 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
3297 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
3298 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
3299 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
3300
3301 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
3302 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
3303 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
3304 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
3305 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
3306 derivations that download files.
3307
3308 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
3309 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
3310 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
3311 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
3312
3313 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
3314 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
3315 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
3316 host CPU instruction set.
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319 @noindent
3320 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
3321 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
3322 to a Bash executable in the store:
3323
3324 @lisp
3325 (use-modules (guix utils)
3326 (guix store)
3327 (guix derivations))
3328
3329 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3330 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3331 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3332 (derivation store "foo"
3333 bash `("-e" ,builder)
3334 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
3335 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
3336 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
3337 @end lisp
3338
3339 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3340 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3341 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3342 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
3343 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
3344
3345 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3346 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3347 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3348 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
3349
3350 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3351 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3352 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3353 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3354 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3355 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3356 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3357 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3358 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3359 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3360 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3361 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3362 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3363 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3364 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3365 gnu-build-system))}.
3366
3367 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3368 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3369 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3370 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3371 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3372 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3373 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3374
3375 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3376 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3377 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
3378
3379 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
3380 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
3381 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
3382 @var{substitutable?}.
3383 @end deffn
3384
3385 @noindent
3386 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3387 containing one file:
3388
3389 @lisp
3390 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
3391 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
3392 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3393 (lambda (p)
3394 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
3395 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
3396
3397 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
3398 @end lisp
3399
3400
3401 @node The Store Monad
3402 @section The Store Monad
3403
3404 @cindex monad
3405
3406 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3407 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3408 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3409 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3410
3411 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3412 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3413 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3414 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3415 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3416
3417 @cindex monadic values
3418 @cindex monadic functions
3419 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3420 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3421 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3422 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3423 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
3424 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
3425 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3426 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3427 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
3428
3429 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3430
3431 @example
3432 (define (sh-symlink store)
3433 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3434 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3435 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3436 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3437 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3438 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
3439 @end example
3440
3441 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3442 as a monadic function:
3443
3444 @example
3445 (define (sh-symlink)
3446 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
3447 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3448 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3449 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3450 #$output))))
3451 @end example
3452
3453 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3454 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3455 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3456 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3457 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3458
3459 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3460 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3461 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3462
3463 @example
3464 (define (sh-symlink)
3465 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3466 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3467 #$output)))
3468 @end example
3469
3470 @c See
3471 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3472 @c for the funny quote.
3473 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3474 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3475 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3476 @code{run-with-store}:
3477
3478 @example
3479 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3480 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
3481 @end example
3482
3483 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
3484 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
3485 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
3486 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3487
3488 @example
3489 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3490 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3491 @end example
3492
3493 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3494 automatically run through the store:
3495
3496 @example
3497 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3498 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3499 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3500 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3501 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3502 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3503 scheme@@(guile-user)>
3504 @end example
3505
3506 @noindent
3507 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3508 @code{store-monad} REPL.
3509
3510 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3511 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
3512
3513 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3514 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3515 in @var{monad}.
3516 @end deffn
3517
3518 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3519 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3520 @end deffn
3521
3522 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
3523 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
3524 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3525 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3526 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3527 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3528 in this example:
3529
3530 @example
3531 (run-with-state
3532 (with-monad %state-monad
3533 (>>= (return 1)
3534 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3535 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3536 'some-state)
3537
3538 @result{} 4
3539 @result{} some-state
3540 @end example
3541 @end deffn
3542
3543 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3544 @var{body} ...
3545 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3546 @var{body} ...
3547 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3548 @var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3549 ``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3550
3551 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3552 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3553 @end deffn
3554
3555 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3556 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3557 returning the result of the last expression.
3558
3559 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3560 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3561 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3562 @end deffn
3563
3564 @cindex state monad
3565 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3566 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3567 monadic procedure calls.
3568
3569 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3570 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3571 the state that is threaded.
3572
3573 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3574 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3575 increments the current state value:
3576
3577 @example
3578 (define (square x)
3579 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3580 (mbegin %state-monad
3581 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3582 (return (* x x)))))
3583
3584 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3585 @result{} (0 1 4)
3586 @result{} 3
3587 @end example
3588
3589 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3590 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3591 @end defvr
3592
3593 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3594 Return the current state as a monadic value.
3595 @end deffn
3596
3597 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3598 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3599 monadic value.
3600 @end deffn
3601
3602 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3603 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3604 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3605 @end deffn
3606
3607 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3608 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3609 The state is assumed to be a list.
3610 @end deffn
3611
3612 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3613 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3614 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3615 @end deffn
3616
3617 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3618 store)} module, is as follows.
3619
3620 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
3621 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3622
3623 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3624 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3625 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
3626 @end defvr
3627
3628 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3629 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3630 open store connection.
3631 @end deffn
3632
3633 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
3634 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
3635 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3636 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
3637 @end deffn
3638
3639 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3640 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
3641 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3642 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3643 @var{name} is omitted.
3644
3645 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3646 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3647 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3648
3649 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
3650 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
3651 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
3652 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
3653
3654 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3655
3656 @example
3657 (run-with-store (open-connection)
3658 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3659 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3660 (return (list a b))))
3661
3662 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3663 @end example
3664
3665 @end deffn
3666
3667 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3668 monadic procedures:
3669
3670 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
3671 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
3672 [#:output "out"]
3673 Return as a monadic
3674 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3675 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
3676 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3677 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
3678 @end deffn
3679
3680 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
3681 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3682 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3683 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3684 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3685 @end deffn
3686
3687
3688 @node G-Expressions
3689 @section G-Expressions
3690
3691 @cindex G-expression
3692 @cindex build code quoting
3693 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3694 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
3695 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
3696 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3697 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3698
3699 @cindex strata of code
3700 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
3701 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3702 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
3703 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3704 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3705 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3706 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3707 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3708 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3709 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3710 @command{make}, etc.
3711
3712 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3713 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
3714 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
3715 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
3716 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
3717 expressions.
3718
3719 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3720 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
3721 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
3722 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
3723 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
3724 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
3725 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
3726 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
3727
3728 @itemize
3729 @item
3730 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3731 processes.
3732
3733 @item
3734 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3735 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3736 introduced.
3737
3738 @item
3739 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3740 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3741 processes that use them.
3742 @end itemize
3743
3744 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3745 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3746 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
3747 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3748 such that these objects can also be inserted
3749 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
3750 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
3751 add files to the store and to refer to them in
3752 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3753 below.)
3754
3755 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3756
3757 @example
3758 (define build-exp
3759 #~(begin
3760 (mkdir #$output)
3761 (chdir #$output)
3762 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3763 "list-files")))
3764 @end example
3765
3766 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3767 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3768 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3769
3770 @example
3771 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3772 @end example
3773
3774 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
3775 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3776 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3777 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
3778 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
3779 output of the derivation.
3780
3781 @cindex cross compilation
3782 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3783 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3784 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3785 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3786 native package build:
3787
3788 @example
3789 (gexp->derivation "vi"
3790 #~(begin
3791 (mkdir #$output)
3792 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3793 "-s"
3794 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3795 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3796 #:target "mips64el-linux")
3797 @end example
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3801 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3802 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3803
3804 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
3805 @findex with-imported-modules
3806 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
3807 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
3808 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
3809 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
3810
3811 @example
3812 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
3813 #~(begin
3814 (use-modules (guix build utils))
3815 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
3816 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
3817 #~(begin
3818 #$build
3819 (display "success!\n")
3820 #t)))
3821 @end example
3822
3823 @noindent
3824 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
3825 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
3826 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
3827
3828 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
3829
3830 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3831 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3832 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3833 or more of the following forms:
3834
3835 @table @code
3836 @item #$@var{obj}
3837 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
3838 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3839 supported types, for example a package or a
3840 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3841 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3842
3843 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3844 objects are substituted similarly.
3845
3846 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3847 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3848
3849 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3850
3851 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3852 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
3853 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
3854 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3855 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
3856
3857 @item #+@var{obj}
3858 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3859 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3860 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3861 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3862 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3863
3864 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
3865 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3866 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3867 output when @var{output} is omitted.
3868
3869 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3870
3871 @item #$@@@var{lst}
3872 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3873 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3874 containing list.
3875
3876 @item #+@@@var{lst}
3877 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3878 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3879 @var{lst}.
3880
3881 @end table
3882
3883 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3884 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3885 @end deffn
3886
3887 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
3888 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
3889 in their execution environment. @var{modules} must be a list of Guile
3890 module names, such as @code{'((guix build utils) (guix build gremlin))}.
3891
3892 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
3893 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
3894 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
3895 @end deffn
3896
3897 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3898 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3899 @end deffn
3900
3901 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3902 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3903 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3904 information about monads.)
3905
3906 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
3907 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
3908 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3909 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
3910 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
3911 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
3912 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
3913 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
3914 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
3915 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
3916 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
3917 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3918 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3919 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3920 to by @var{exp}.
3921
3922 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
3923 Its meaning is to
3924 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3925 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3926 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
3927 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3928 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3929
3930 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3931 applicable.
3932
3933 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3934 following forms:
3935
3936 @example
3937 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
3938 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3939 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3940 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3941 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3942 @end example
3943
3944 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3945 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3946 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3947 text format.
3948
3949 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3950 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3951 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3952 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
3953 referenced by the outputs.
3954
3955 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
3956 @end deffn
3957
3958 @cindex file-like objects
3959 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3960 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3961 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3962 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
3963
3964 @example
3965 #~(system* (string-append #$glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3966 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3967 @end example
3968
3969 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3970 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3971 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3972 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3973 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3974 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3975 content is directly passed as a string.
3976
3977 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3978 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
3979 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
3980 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
3981 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
3982 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
3983
3984 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
3985 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
3986 permission bits are kept.
3987
3988 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
3989 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
3990 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
3991 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
3992
3993 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
3994 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
3995 @end deffn
3996
3997 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
3998 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
3999 @var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
4000
4001 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
4002 @end deffn
4003
4004 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
4005 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
4006 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
4007 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
4008 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
4009
4010 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
4011 @end deffn
4012
4013 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
4014 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
4015 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
4016
4017 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
4018 command:
4019
4020 @example
4021 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
4022
4023 (gexp->script "list-files"
4024 #~(execl (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
4025 "ls"))
4026 @end example
4027
4028 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
4029 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
4030 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
4031
4032 @example
4033 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
4034 !#
4035 (execl (string-append "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls")
4036 "ls")
4037 @end example
4038 @end deffn
4039
4040 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4041 [#:guile #f]
4042 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
4043 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
4044 script.
4045
4046 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
4047 @end deffn
4048
4049 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
4050 [#:set-load-path? #t]
4051 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
4052 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
4053 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
4054 @var{exp}'s imported modules.
4055
4056 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
4057 or a subset thereof.
4058 @end deffn
4059
4060 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
4061 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
4062 @var{exp}.
4063
4064 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
4065 @end deffn
4066
4067 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4068 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
4069 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
4070 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
4071 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
4072 references to all these.
4073
4074 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
4075 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
4076 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
4077 like this:
4078
4079 @example
4080 (define (profile.sh)
4081 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
4082 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
4083 (text-file* "profile.sh"
4084 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
4085 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
4086 @end example
4087
4088 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
4089 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
4090 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
4091 @end deffn
4092
4093 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
4094 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
4095 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
4096 as in:
4097
4098 @example
4099 (mixed-text-file "profile"
4100 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
4101 @end example
4102
4103 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
4104 @end deffn
4105
4106 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
4107 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
4108 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
4109 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
4110
4111 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
4112 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
4113 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
4114 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
4115 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
4116
4117 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
4118 [#:target #f]
4119 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
4120 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
4121 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
4122 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
4123 @end deffn
4124
4125
4126 @c *********************************************************************
4127 @node Utilities
4128 @chapter Utilities
4129
4130 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
4131 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
4132 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
4133 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
4134
4135 @menu
4136 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
4137 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
4138 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
4139 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
4140 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
4141 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
4142 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
4143 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
4144 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
4145 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4146 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
4147 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
4148 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
4149 @end menu
4150
4151 @node Invoking guix build
4152 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
4153
4154 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
4155 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
4156 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
4157 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
4158 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
4159
4160 The general syntax is:
4161
4162 @example
4163 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
4164 @end example
4165
4166 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
4167 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
4168 resulting directories:
4169
4170 @example
4171 guix build emacs guile
4172 @end example
4173
4174 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
4175
4176 @example
4177 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
4178 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
4179 @end example
4180
4181 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
4182 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
4183 @code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
4184 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
4185 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
4186 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4187
4188 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
4189 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
4190 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
4191 needed.
4192
4193 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
4194 described in the subsections below.
4195
4196 @menu
4197 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
4198 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
4199 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
4200 @end menu
4201
4202 @node Common Build Options
4203 @subsection Common Build Options
4204
4205 A number of options that control the build process are common to
4206 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
4207 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
4208 following:
4209
4210 @table @code
4211
4212 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
4213 @itemx -L @var{directory}
4214 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
4215 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
4216
4217 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
4218 the command-line tools.
4219
4220 @item --keep-failed
4221 @itemx -K
4222 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
4223 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
4224 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
4225
4226 @item --keep-going
4227 @itemx -k
4228 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
4229 all the builds have either completed or failed.
4230
4231 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
4232 derivations has failed.
4233
4234 @item --dry-run
4235 @itemx -n
4236 Do not build the derivations.
4237
4238 @item --fallback
4239 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
4240 packages locally.
4241
4242 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4243 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
4244 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
4245 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
4246 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
4247
4248 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
4249 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
4250 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4251
4252 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
4253 disabled.
4254
4255 @item --no-substitutes
4256 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
4257 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
4258 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
4259
4260 @item --no-grafts
4261 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4262 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4263 information on grafts.
4264
4265 @item --rounds=@var{n}
4266 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
4267 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
4268
4269 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
4270 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
4271 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
4272 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
4273
4274 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
4275 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
4276 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
4277 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
4278 the two results.
4279
4280 @item --no-build-hook
4281 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
4282 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
4283 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
4284
4285 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
4286 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
4287 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4288
4289 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
4290 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
4291 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
4292
4293 By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
4294 @code{--timeout=0}.
4295
4296 @item --verbosity=@var{level}
4297 Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
4298 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
4299 may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
4300
4301 @item --cores=@var{n}
4302 @itemx -c @var{n}
4303 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
4304 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
4305
4306 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
4307 @itemx -M @var{n}
4308 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
4309 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
4310 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
4311
4312 @end table
4313
4314 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
4315 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
4316 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
4317 derivations)} module.
4318
4319 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
4320 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
4321 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
4322
4323 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
4324 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
4325 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
4326 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
4327 below:
4328
4329 @example
4330 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
4331 @end example
4332
4333 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
4334 the parsed command-line options.
4335 @end defvr
4336
4337
4338 @node Package Transformation Options
4339 @subsection Package Transformation Options
4340
4341 @cindex package variants
4342 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
4343 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
4344 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
4345 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
4346 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
4347 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
4348 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4349
4350 @table @code
4351
4352 @item --with-source=@var{source}
4353 Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
4354 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
4355 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
4356
4357 The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be the one specified on the
4358 command line the name of which matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
4359 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
4360 package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
4361 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
4362
4363 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
4364 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
4365 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
4366 the @code{ed} package:
4367
4368 @example
4369 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
4370 @end example
4371
4372 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
4373 candidates:
4374
4375 @example
4376 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
4377 @end example
4378
4379 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
4380
4381 @example
4382 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
4383 $ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
4384 @end example
4385
4386 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4387 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4388 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4389 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4390 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4391
4392 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
4393 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4394 the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4395
4396 @example
4397 guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4398 @end example
4399
4400 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4401 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4402 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4403
4404 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
4405 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
4406 @end table
4407
4408 @node Additional Build Options
4409 @subsection Additional Build Options
4410
4411 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4412 build}.
4413
4414 @table @code
4415
4416 @item --quiet
4417 @itemx -q
4418 Build quietly, without displaying the build log. Upon completion, the
4419 build log is kept in @file{/var} (or similar) and can always be
4420 retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
4421
4422 @item --file=@var{file}
4423 @itemx -f @var{file}
4424
4425 Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4426 evaluates to.
4427
4428 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4429 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4430
4431 @example
4432 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4433 @end example
4434
4435 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4436 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4437 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
4438
4439 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
4440 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4441 version 1.8 of Guile.
4442
4443 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
4444 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4445 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4446
4447 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
4448 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4449 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4450
4451 @item --source
4452 @itemx -S
4453 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
4454 themselves.
4455
4456 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
4457 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
4458 source tarball.
4459
4460 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
4461 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
4462 Packages}).
4463
4464 @item --sources
4465 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4466 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4467 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4468 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4469 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4470 optional argument values:
4471
4472 @table @code
4473 @item package
4474 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4475 as the @code{--source} option.
4476
4477 @item all
4478 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
4479 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
4480
4481 @example
4482 $ guix build --sources tzdata
4483 The following derivations will be built:
4484 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4485 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4486 @end example
4487
4488 @item transitive
4489 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
4490 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
4491 prefetch package source for later offline building.
4492
4493 @example
4494 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4495 The following derivations will be built:
4496 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4497 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4498 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4499 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4500 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4501 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4502 @dots{}
4503 @end example
4504
4505 @end table
4506
4507 @item --system=@var{system}
4508 @itemx -s @var{system}
4509 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4510 the system type of the build host.
4511
4512 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4513 different personalities. For instance, passing
4514 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4515 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4516
4517 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4518 @cindex cross-compilation
4519 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4520 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4521 configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4522
4523 @anchor{build-check}
4524 @item --check
4525 @cindex determinism, checking
4526 @cindex reproducibility, checking
4527 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4528 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4529 identical.
4530
4531 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
4532 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
4533 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
4534 background information and tools.
4535
4536 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
4537 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
4538 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
4539
4540 @item --derivations
4541 @itemx -d
4542 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4543 packages.
4544
4545 @item --root=@var{file}
4546 @itemx -r @var{file}
4547 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4548 collector root.
4549
4550 @item --log-file
4551 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
4552 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
4553 missing.
4554
4555 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4556 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4557
4558 @example
4559 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4560 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4561 guix build --log-file guile
4562 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4563 @end example
4564
4565 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4566 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4567 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
4568
4569 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
4570 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
4571
4572 @example
4573 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4574 https://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4575 @end example
4576
4577 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
4578 @end table
4579
4580
4581 @node Invoking guix edit
4582 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4583
4584 @cindex package definition, editing
4585 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4586 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
4587 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
4588 For instance:
4589
4590 @example
4591 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
4592 @end example
4593
4594 @noindent
4595 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4596 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
4597 and that of Vim.
4598
4599 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
4600 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
4601 (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will be able to edit the package
4602 recipes. Otherwise, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
4603 for packages currently in the store.
4604
4605 If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides the
4606 @kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
4607 info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by the @kbd{M-x
4608 guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
4609
4610
4611 @node Invoking guix download
4612 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
4613
4614 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
4615 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
4616 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4617 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4618 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4619 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4620
4621 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4622 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4623 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4624 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4625 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4626 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4627
4628 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4629 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4630 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4631 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
4632 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4633 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4634 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
4635
4636 The following option is available:
4637
4638 @table @code
4639 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4640 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4641 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
4642 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
4643 @end table
4644
4645 @node Invoking guix hash
4646 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4647
4648 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
4649 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4650 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4651 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4652
4653 The general syntax is:
4654
4655 @example
4656 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4657 @end example
4658
4659 @command{guix hash} has the following option:
4660
4661 @table @code
4662
4663 @item --format=@var{fmt}
4664 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
4665 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
4666
4667 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4668 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4669
4670 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4671 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4672 in the definitions of packages.
4673
4674 @item --recursive
4675 @itemx -r
4676 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4677
4678 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
4679 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
4680 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
4681 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
4682 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
4683 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4684 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4685 @c it exists.
4686
4687 @vindex git-fetch
4688 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
4689 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
4690 Reference}):
4691
4692 @example
4693 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
4694 $ cd foo
4695 $ rm -rf .git
4696 $ guix hash -r .
4697 @end example
4698 @end table
4699
4700 @node Invoking guix import
4701 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
4702
4703 @cindex importing packages
4704 @cindex package import
4705 @cindex package conversion
4706 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
4707 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
4708 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4709 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
4710 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4711 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4712
4713 The general syntax is:
4714
4715 @example
4716 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4717 @end example
4718
4719 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
4720 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
4721 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4722 ``importers'' are:
4723
4724 @table @code
4725 @item gnu
4726 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
4727 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4728 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4729
4730 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
4731 license needs to be figured out manually.
4732
4733 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4734 GNU@tie{}Hello:
4735
4736 @example
4737 guix import gnu hello
4738 @end example
4739
4740 Specific command-line options are:
4741
4742 @table @code
4743 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
4744 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
4745 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
4746 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4747 @end table
4748
4749 @item pypi
4750 @cindex pypi
4751 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
4752 Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4753 @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4754 description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4755 the relevant information, including package dependencies. For maximum
4756 efficiency, it is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so
4757 that the importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
4758
4759 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
4760 package:
4761
4762 @example
4763 guix import pypi itsdangerous
4764 @end example
4765
4766 @item gem
4767 @cindex gem
4768 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
4769 RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4770 installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4771 JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4772 most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
4773 some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
4774 synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4775 Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4776 native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4777 packager.
4778
4779 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
4780
4781 @example
4782 guix import gem rails
4783 @end example
4784
4785 @item cpan
4786 @cindex CPAN
4787 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}@footnote{This
4788 functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4789 @xref{Requirements}.}.
4790 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
4791 @uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
4792 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4793 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4794 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4795 list of dependencies.
4796
4797 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
4798 Perl module:
4799
4800 @example
4801 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4802 @end example
4803
4804 @item cran
4805 @cindex CRAN
4806 @cindex Bioconductor
4807 Import metadata from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
4808 central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4809 statistical and graphical environment}.
4810
4811 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
4812
4813 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
4814 R package:
4815
4816 @example
4817 guix import cran Cairo
4818 @end example
4819
4820 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
4821 @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4822 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4823 genomic data in bioinformatics.
4824
4825 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
4826 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4827
4828 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
4829 R package:
4830
4831 @example
4832 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4833 @end example
4834
4835 @item nix
4836 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
4837 @uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4838 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4839 @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4840 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4841 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4842 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4843 package definition.
4844
4845 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4846 by their canonical upstream variant.
4847
4848 Usually, you will first need to do:
4849
4850 @example
4851 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4852 @end example
4853
4854 @noindent
4855 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4856
4857 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4858 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4859 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4860
4861 @example
4862 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4863 @end example
4864
4865 @item hackage
4866 @cindex hackage
4867 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
4868 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4869 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4870 dependencies.
4871
4872 Specific command-line options are:
4873
4874 @table @code
4875 @item --stdin
4876 @itemx -s
4877 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
4878 @item --no-test-dependencies
4879 @itemx -t
4880 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
4881 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4882 @itemx -e @var{alist}
4883 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4884 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4885 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4886 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4887 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4888 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4889 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
4890 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
4891 @end table
4892
4893 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
4894 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4895 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
4896
4897 @example
4898 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
4899 @end example
4900
4901 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4902 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
4903
4904 @example
4905 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
4906 @end example
4907
4908 @item elpa
4909 @cindex elpa
4910 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
4911 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4912
4913 Specific command-line options are:
4914
4915 @table @code
4916 @item --archive=@var{repo}
4917 @itemx -a @var{repo}
4918 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4919 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4920 are:
4921 @itemize -
4922 @item
4923 @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
4924 identifier. This is the default.
4925
4926 @item
4927 @uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
4928 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4929
4930 @item
4931 @uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
4932 identifier.
4933 @end itemize
4934 @end table
4935 @end table
4936
4937 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4938 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4939 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4940
4941 @node Invoking guix refresh
4942 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4943
4944 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4945 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
4946 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
4947 upstream version, like this:
4948
4949 @example
4950 $ guix refresh
4951 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
4952 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
4953 @end example
4954
4955 It does so by browsing the FTP directory of each package and determining
4956 the highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
4957 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
4958 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
4959 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
4960 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
4961 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
4962
4963 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
4964 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
4965 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
4966 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
4967 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
4968 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
4969 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
4970 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
4971 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
4972 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
4973
4974 The following options are supported:
4975
4976 @table @code
4977
4978 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4979 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4980 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4981
4982 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4983
4984 @example
4985 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
4986 @end example
4987
4988 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
4989 the packages.)
4990
4991 @item --update
4992 @itemx -u
4993 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
4994 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
4995 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
4996
4997 @example
4998 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
4999 @end example
5000
5001 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
5002
5003 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
5004 @itemx -s @var{subset}
5005 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
5006 @code{non-core}.
5007
5008 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
5009 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
5010 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
5011 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
5012 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
5013 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
5014
5015 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
5016 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
5017 inconvenient.
5018
5019 @item --type=@var{updater}
5020 @itemx -t @var{updater}
5021 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
5022 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
5023
5024 @table @code
5025 @item gnu
5026 the updater for GNU packages;
5027 @item gnome
5028 the updater for GNOME packages;
5029 @item kde
5030 the updater for KDE packages;
5031 @item xorg
5032 the updater for X.org packages;
5033 @item elpa
5034 the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
5035 @item cran
5036 the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
5037 @item bioconductor
5038 the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
5039 @item pypi
5040 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
5041 @item gem
5042 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
5043 @item github
5044 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
5045 @item hackage
5046 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
5047 @end table
5048
5049 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
5050 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
5051
5052 @example
5053 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
5054 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
5055 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
5056 @end example
5057
5058 @end table
5059
5060 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
5061 names, as in this example:
5062
5063 @example
5064 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
5065 @end example
5066
5067 @noindent
5068 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
5069 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
5070 effect in this case.
5071
5072 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
5073 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
5074 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
5075 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
5076
5077 @table @code
5078
5079 @item --list-updaters
5080 @itemx -L
5081 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
5082
5083 @item --list-dependent
5084 @itemx -l
5085 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
5086 result of upgrading one or more packages.
5087
5088 @end table
5089
5090 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
5091 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
5092 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
5093
5094 @example
5095 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
5096 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
5097 hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
5098 @end example
5099
5100 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
5101 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
5102
5103 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
5104
5105 @table @code
5106
5107 @item --gpg=@var{command}
5108 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
5109 for in @code{$PATH}.
5110
5111 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
5112 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
5113 of:
5114
5115 @table @code
5116 @item always
5117 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
5118 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
5119
5120 @item never
5121 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
5122
5123 @item interactive
5124 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
5125 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
5126 @end table
5127
5128 @item --key-server=@var{host}
5129 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
5130
5131 @end table
5132
5133 The @code{github} updater uses the
5134 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
5135 releases. When used repeatedly e.g. when refreshing all packages,
5136 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
5137 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
5138 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
5139 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
5140 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
5141 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
5142 otherwise.
5143
5144
5145 @node Invoking guix lint
5146 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
5147 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
5148 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
5149 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
5150 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
5151 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
5152
5153 @table @code
5154 @item synopsis
5155 @itemx description
5156 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
5157 descriptions and synopses.
5158
5159 @item inputs-should-be-native
5160 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
5161
5162 @item source
5163 @itemx home-page
5164 @itemx source-file-name
5165 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
5166 invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
5167 just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
5168 @code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
5169
5170 @item cve
5171 @cindex security vulnerabilities
5172 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
5173 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
5174 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
5175 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
5176 NIST}.
5177
5178 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
5179
5180 @itemize
5181 @item
5182 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5183 @item
5184 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
5185 @end itemize
5186
5187 @noindent
5188 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
5189 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
5190
5191 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
5192 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
5193 name and version of the package when they differ from the name that Guix
5194 uses, as in this example:
5195
5196 @example
5197 (package
5198 (name "grub")
5199 ;; @dots{}
5200 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
5201 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2"))))
5202 @end example
5203
5204 @item formatting
5205 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
5206 use of tabulations, etc.
5207 @end table
5208
5209 The general syntax is:
5210
5211 @example
5212 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5213 @end example
5214
5215 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
5216 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
5217
5218 @table @code
5219 @item --list-checkers
5220 @itemx -l
5221 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
5222 and exit.
5223
5224 @item --checkers
5225 @itemx -c
5226 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
5227 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
5228
5229 @end table
5230
5231 @node Invoking guix size
5232 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
5233
5234 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
5235 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
5236 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
5237 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
5238 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
5239 @command{guix size} can highlight.
5240
5241 The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
5242 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
5243 example:
5244
5245 @example
5246 $ guix size coreutils
5247 store item total self
5248 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
5249 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
5250 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
5251 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
5252 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
5253 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
5254 @end example
5255
5256 @cindex closure
5257 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
5258 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
5259 would be returned by:
5260
5261 @example
5262 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
5263 @end example
5264
5265 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
5266 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
5267 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
5268 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
5269 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
5270 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
5271
5272 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
5273 70@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
5274 large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
5275 always available on the system anyway.)
5276
5277 When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
5278 store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
5279 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
5280 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
5281 Coreutils}).
5282
5283 When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
5284 reports information based on the available substitutes
5285 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
5286 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
5287
5288 You can also specify several package names:
5289
5290 @example
5291 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
5292 store item total self
5293 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
5294 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
5295 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
5296 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
5297 @dots{}
5298 total: 102.3 MiB
5299 @end example
5300
5301 @noindent
5302 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
5303 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
5304 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
5305
5306 The available options are:
5307
5308 @table @option
5309
5310 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5311 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
5312 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
5313
5314 @item --map-file=@var{file}
5315 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
5316
5317 For the example above, the map looks like this:
5318
5319 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
5320 produced by @command{guix size}}
5321
5322 This option requires that
5323 @uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
5324 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
5325 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
5326
5327 @item --system=@var{system}
5328 @itemx -s @var{system}
5329 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
5330
5331 @end table
5332
5333 @node Invoking guix graph
5334 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
5335
5336 @cindex DAG
5337 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
5338 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
5339 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
5340 provides a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix graph}
5341 emits a DAG representation in the input format of
5342 @uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
5343 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. The general
5344 syntax is:
5345
5346 @example
5347 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5348 @end example
5349
5350 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
5351 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
5352 dependencies:
5353
5354 @example
5355 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5356 @end example
5357
5358 The output looks like this:
5359
5360 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5361
5362 Nice little graph, no?
5363
5364 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
5365 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
5366 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
5367 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
5368 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
5369
5370 @table @code
5371 @item package
5372 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
5373 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
5374 filters out many details.
5375
5376 @item bag-emerged
5377 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
5378
5379 For instance, the following command:
5380
5381 @example
5382 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
5383 @end example
5384
5385 ... yields this bigger graph:
5386
5387 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
5388
5389 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
5390 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
5391
5392 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
5393 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
5394 here, for conciseness.
5395
5396 @item bag
5397 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
5398 dependencies.
5399
5400 @item bag-with-origins
5401 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
5402
5403 @item derivations
5404 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
5405 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
5406 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
5407 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
5408
5409 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
5410 name instead of a package name, as in:
5411
5412 @example
5413 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
5414 @end example
5415 @end table
5416
5417 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
5418 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
5419
5420 @table @code
5421 @item references
5422 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
5423 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
5424
5425 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
5426 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
5427
5428 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
5429 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
5430 (which can be big!):
5431
5432 @example
5433 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
5434 @end example
5435 @end table
5436
5437 The available options are the following:
5438
5439 @table @option
5440 @item --type=@var{type}
5441 @itemx -t @var{type}
5442 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
5443 the values listed above.
5444
5445 @item --list-types
5446 List the supported graph types.
5447
5448 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5449 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5450 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
5451
5452 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
5453
5454 @example
5455 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
5456 @end example
5457 @end table
5458
5459
5460 @node Invoking guix environment
5461 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
5462
5463 @cindex reproducible build environments
5464 @cindex development environments
5465 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
5466 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
5467 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
5468 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
5469 environment to use them.
5470
5471 The general syntax is:
5472
5473 @example
5474 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
5475 @end example
5476
5477 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
5478 GNU@tie{}Guile:
5479
5480 @example
5481 guix environment guile
5482 @end example
5483
5484 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
5485 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
5486 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
5487 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
5488 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
5489 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
5490 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
5491 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
5492 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
5493 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
5494 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
5495 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
5496 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
5497 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5498 details on Bash start-up files.}.
5499
5500 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5501 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
5502 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
5503 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
5504 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5505 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5506
5507 @example
5508 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5509 then
5510 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5511 fi
5512 @end example
5513
5514 @noindent
5515 ... or to browse the profile:
5516
5517 @example
5518 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
5519 @end example
5520
5521 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5522 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5523 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5524 and Emacs are available:
5525
5526 @example
5527 guix environment guile emacs
5528 @end example
5529
5530 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5531 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5532 command from the rest of the arguments:
5533
5534 @example
5535 guix environment guile -- make -j4
5536 @end example
5537
5538 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5539 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5540 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5541 NumPy:
5542
5543 @example
5544 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
5545 @end example
5546
5547 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5548 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5549 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5550 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5551 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5552 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5553 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5554 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5555 additionally includes Git and strace:
5556
5557 @example
5558 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5559 @end example
5560
5561 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5562 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5563 using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5564 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5565 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5566 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5567 working directory are mounted:
5568
5569 @example
5570 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5571 @end example
5572
5573 @quotation Note
5574 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
5575 @end quotation
5576
5577 The available options are summarized below.
5578
5579 @table @code
5580 @item --expression=@var{expr}
5581 @itemx -e @var{expr}
5582 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5583 @var{expr} evaluates to.
5584
5585 For example, running:
5586
5587 @example
5588 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5589 @end example
5590
5591 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5592 PETSc package.
5593
5594 Running:
5595
5596 @example
5597 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
5598 @end example
5599
5600 starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5601
5602 The above commands only the use default output of the given packages.
5603 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5604
5605 @example
5606 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5607 @end example
5608
5609 @item --load=@var{file}
5610 @itemx -l @var{file}
5611 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5612 within @var{file} evaluates to.
5613
5614 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5615 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5616
5617 @example
5618 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5619 @end example
5620
5621 @item --ad-hoc
5622 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5623 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5624 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5625 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5626
5627 For instance, the command:
5628
5629 @example
5630 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
5631 @end example
5632
5633 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5634 available.
5635
5636 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
5637 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
5638 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5639 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5640
5641 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5642 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5643 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5644 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5645 that will be added to the environment directly.
5646
5647 @item --pure
5648 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5649 This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5650 only contain package inputs.
5651
5652 @item --search-paths
5653 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5654 environment.
5655
5656 @item --system=@var{system}
5657 @itemx -s @var{system}
5658 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
5659
5660 @item --container
5661 @itemx -C
5662 @cindex container
5663 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
5664 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
5665 Additionally, a dummy home directory is created that matches the current
5666 user's home directory, and @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
5667 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container, but
5668 has root privileges in the context of the container.
5669
5670 @item --network
5671 @itemx -N
5672 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5673 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5674 device.
5675
5676 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5677 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5678 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5679 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5680 point in the container.
5681
5682 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5683 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5684 directory:
5685
5686 @example
5687 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5688 @end example
5689
5690 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5691 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5692 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5693 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5694 point in the container.
5695
5696 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5697 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5698 @file{/exchange} directory:
5699
5700 @example
5701 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5702 @end example
5703 @end table
5704
5705 It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
5706 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
5707
5708 @node Invoking guix publish
5709 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5710
5711 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
5712 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
5713 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
5714
5715 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5716 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5717 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5718 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5719 the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
5720
5721 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5722 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
5723 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
5724 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5725 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
5726
5727 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5728 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5729 guix archive}).
5730
5731 The general syntax is:
5732
5733 @example
5734 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5735 @end example
5736
5737 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5738 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5739
5740 @example
5741 guix publish
5742 @end example
5743
5744 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5745 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5746
5747 @example
5748 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5749 @end example
5750
5751 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
5752 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
5753 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
5754 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
5755 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
5756 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
5757
5758 @example
5759 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
5760 @end example
5761
5762 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
5763 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
5764
5765 The following options are available:
5766
5767 @table @code
5768 @item --port=@var{port}
5769 @itemx -p @var{port}
5770 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5771
5772 @item --listen=@var{host}
5773 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5774 accept connections from any interface.
5775
5776 @item --user=@var{user}
5777 @itemx -u @var{user}
5778 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5779 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5780
5781 @item --compression[=@var{level}]
5782 @itemx -C [@var{level}]
5783 Compress data using the given @var{level}. When @var{level} is zero,
5784 disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds to different gzip
5785 compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best (CPU-intensive).
5786 The default is 3.
5787
5788 Compression occurs on the fly and the compressed streams are not
5789 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
5790 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, or to
5791 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy.
5792
5793 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
5794 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
5795 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
5796 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
5797
5798 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
5799 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
5800 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
5801 for as long as @var{ttl}.
5802
5803 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
5804 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
5805 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
5806 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5807 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
5808 @end table
5809
5810 Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5811 add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5812 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5813 @code{guix-publish-service}}).
5814
5815
5816 @node Invoking guix challenge
5817 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5818
5819 @cindex reproducible builds
5820 @cindex verifiable builds
5821
5822 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
5823 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
5824 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5825 answer.
5826
5827 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
5828 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
5829 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5830 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5831 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5832 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5833 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5834
5835 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5836 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5837 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5838 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5839 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5840 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5841 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5842 any given store item.
5843
5844 The command output looks like this:
5845
5846 @smallexample
5847 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://hydra.gnu.org https://guix.example.org"
5848 updating list of substitutes from 'https://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5849 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5850 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5851 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5852 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5853 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5854 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5855 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5856 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5857 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5858 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5859 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5860 https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5861 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5862 @end smallexample
5863
5864 @noindent
5865 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5866 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5867 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5868 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5869 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5870
5871 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5872 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5873 Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5874 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5875 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5876 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5877 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5878 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5879 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5880 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
5881 more information.
5882
5883 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
5884 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5885
5886 @example
5887 $ wget -q -O - https://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5888 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
5889 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
5890 @end example
5891
5892 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5893 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5894 @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5895 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5896 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5897 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5898 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5899
5900 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
5901 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5902 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
5903 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
5904 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
5905 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5906 the problem.
5907
5908 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5909 whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5910 same build result as you did with:
5911
5912 @example
5913 $ guix challenge @var{package}
5914 @end example
5915
5916 @noindent
5917 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
5918 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5919
5920 The general syntax is:
5921
5922 @example
5923 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5924 @end example
5925
5926 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
5927 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
5928 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
5929 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
5930 errors.)
5931
5932 The one option that matters is:
5933
5934 @table @code
5935
5936 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5937 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5938 URLs to compare to.
5939
5940 @end table
5941
5942
5943 @node Invoking guix container
5944 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
5945 @cindex container
5946
5947 @quotation Note
5948 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
5949 is subject to radical change in the future.
5950 @end quotation
5951
5952 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
5953 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
5954 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
5955 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
5956 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
5957
5958 The general syntax is:
5959
5960 @example
5961 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
5962 @end example
5963
5964 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
5965 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
5966
5967 The following actions are available:
5968
5969 @table @code
5970 @item exec
5971 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
5972
5973 The syntax is:
5974
5975 @example
5976 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
5977 @end example
5978
5979 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
5980 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
5981 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
5982 will be passed to @var{program}.
5983
5984 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
5985 GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
5986 process ID is 9001:
5987
5988 @example
5989 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
5990 @end example
5991
5992 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
5993 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
5994
5995 @end table
5996
5997 @c *********************************************************************
5998 @node GNU Distribution
5999 @chapter GNU Distribution
6000
6001 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6002 @cindex GuixSD
6003 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
6004 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
6005 @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
6006 users of that software}.}. The
6007 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
6008 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
6009 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
6010 between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
6011 System Distribution, or GuixSD.
6012
6013 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
6014 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
6015 list of available packages can be browsed
6016 @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
6017 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
6018
6019 @example
6020 guix package --list-available
6021 @end example
6022
6023 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
6024 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
6025 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
6026 tools that help users exert that freedom.
6027
6028 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
6029
6030 @table @code
6031
6032 @item x86_64-linux
6033 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
6034
6035 @item i686-linux
6036 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
6037
6038 @item armhf-linux
6039 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
6040 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
6041 and Linux-Libre kernel.
6042
6043 @item mips64el-linux
6044 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
6045 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
6046
6047 @end table
6048
6049 GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
6050
6051 @noindent
6052 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
6053 @pxref{Porting}.
6054
6055 @menu
6056 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
6057 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
6058 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
6059 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
6060 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
6061 * Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
6062 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
6063 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
6064 @end menu
6065
6066 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
6067 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
6068
6069 @node System Installation
6070 @section System Installation
6071
6072 @cindex Guix System Distribution
6073 This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD)
6074 on a machine. The Guix package manager can
6075 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
6076 @pxref{Installation}.
6077
6078 @ifinfo
6079 @quotation Note
6080 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
6081 @c installation image.
6082 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
6083 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6084 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
6085 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
6086
6087 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
6088 available.
6089 @end quotation
6090 @end ifinfo
6091
6092 @menu
6093 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
6094 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
6095 * USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
6096 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
6097 * Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
6098 * Installing GuixSD in a VM:: GuixSD playground.
6099 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
6100 @end menu
6101
6102 @node Limitations
6103 @subsection Limitations
6104
6105 As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
6106 not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
6107 features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
6108 respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
6109 is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
6110 the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
6111 to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
6112 also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
6113 of it (@pxref{Installation}).
6114
6115 Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
6116 noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
6117
6118 @itemize
6119 @item
6120 The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
6121 requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
6122 get a feel of what that means.)
6123
6124 @item
6125 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
6126
6127 @item
6128 Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
6129 (@pxref{Services}).
6130
6131 @item
6132 More than 3,200 packages are available, but you may
6133 occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
6134
6135 @item
6136 GNOME, Xfce, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
6137 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, some graphical
6138 applications may be missing, as well as KDE.
6139 @end itemize
6140
6141 You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
6142 to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
6143 @xref{Contributing}, for more info.
6144
6145
6146 @node Hardware Considerations
6147 @subsection Hardware Considerations
6148
6149 @cindex hardware support on GuixSD
6150 GNU@tie{}GuixSD focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
6151 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
6152 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
6153 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
6154 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
6155 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
6156 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
6157 hardware is not supported on GuixSD.
6158
6159 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
6160 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
6161 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
6162 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
6163 driver, and for which free firmware exists and is available
6164 out-of-the-box on GuixSD, as part of @var{%base-firmware}
6165 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
6166
6167 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
6168 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
6169 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
6170 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
6171 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
6172 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
6173
6174 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
6175 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
6176 about their support in GNU/Linux.
6177
6178
6179 @node USB Stick Installation
6180 @subsection USB Stick Installation
6181
6182 An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
6183 @indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
6184 where @var{system} is one of:
6185
6186 @table @code
6187 @item x86_64-linux
6188 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
6189
6190 @item i686-linux
6191 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
6192 @end table
6193
6194 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
6195 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
6196 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
6197
6198 @example
6199 $ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6200 $ gpg --verify guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz.sig
6201 @end example
6202
6203 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
6204 then run this command to import it:
6205
6206 @example
6207 $ gpg --keyserver pgp.mit.edu --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
6208 @end example
6209
6210 @noindent
6211 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
6212 @c end duplication
6213
6214 This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
6215 installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
6216 USB stick.
6217
6218 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
6219
6220 @enumerate
6221 @item
6222 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
6223
6224 @example
6225 xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
6226 @end example
6227
6228 @item
6229 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
6230 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
6231 copy the image with:
6232
6233 @example
6234 dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
6235 @end example
6236
6237 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
6238 @end enumerate
6239
6240 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
6241 the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
6242 menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
6243
6244 @xref{Installing GuixSD in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
6245 GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM).
6246
6247 @node Preparing for Installation
6248 @subsection Preparing for Installation
6249
6250 Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
6251 end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
6252 be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
6253 browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
6254 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse
6255 daemon, which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and
6256 to paste it with the middle button.
6257
6258 @quotation Note
6259 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
6260 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
6261 ``Networking'' section below.
6262 @end quotation
6263
6264 The installation system includes many common tools needed for this task.
6265 But it is also a full-blown GuixSD system, which means that you can
6266 install additional packages, should you need it, using @command{guix
6267 package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
6268
6269 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
6270
6271 @cindex keyboard layout
6272 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
6273 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
6274 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
6275
6276 @example
6277 loadkeys dvorak
6278 @end example
6279
6280 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
6281 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
6282 more information.
6283
6284 @subsubsection Networking
6285
6286 Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
6287
6288 @example
6289 ifconfig -a
6290 @end example
6291
6292 @noindent
6293 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
6294
6295 @example
6296 ip a
6297 @end example
6298
6299 @c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
6300 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
6301 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
6302 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
6303 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
6304
6305 @table @asis
6306 @item Wired connection
6307 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
6308 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
6309
6310 @example
6311 ifconfig @var{interface} up
6312 @end example
6313
6314 @item Wireless connection
6315 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
6316 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
6317 important) using one of the available text editors such as
6318 @command{zile}:
6319
6320 @example
6321 zile wpa_supplicant.conf
6322 @end example
6323
6324 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
6325 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
6326 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
6327
6328 @example
6329 network=@{
6330 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
6331 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
6332 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
6333 @}
6334 @end example
6335
6336 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
6337 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
6338 network interface you want to use):
6339
6340 @example
6341 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
6342 @end example
6343
6344 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
6345 @end table
6346
6347 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
6348 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
6349
6350 @example
6351 dhclient -v @var{interface}
6352 @end example
6353
6354 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
6355
6356 @example
6357 ping -c 3 gnu.org
6358 @end example
6359
6360 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
6361 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
6362
6363 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
6364
6365 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
6366 then format the target partition(s).
6367
6368 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
6369 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
6370 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
6371 the partition layout you want:
6372
6373 @example
6374 cfdisk
6375 @end example
6376
6377 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
6378 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
6379 GuixSD pretty much assumes an ext4 file system. In particular, code
6380 that reads partition UUIDs and labels only works with ext4. This will
6381 be fixed in the future.}.
6382
6383 Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
6384 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
6385 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
6386 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
6387 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
6388 @code{my-root} can be created with:
6389
6390 @example
6391 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
6392 @end example
6393
6394 @c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
6395 @c A typical command sequence may be:
6396 @c
6397 @c @example
6398 @c # fdisk /dev/sdX
6399 @c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
6400 @c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
6401 @c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
6402 @c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
6403 @c @end example
6404
6405 In addition to e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
6406 ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems, the installation image includes
6407 Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk encryption.
6408
6409 Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}
6410 with a command like (again, assuming @file{/dev/sda1} is the root
6411 partition):
6412
6413 @example
6414 mount /dev/sda1 /mnt
6415 @end example
6416
6417 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
6418 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
6419 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
6420 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, you would run:
6421
6422 @example
6423 mkswap /dev/sda2
6424 @end example
6425
6426 @node Proceeding with the Installation
6427 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
6428
6429 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
6430 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
6431
6432 @example
6433 herd start cow-store /mnt
6434 @end example
6435
6436 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
6437 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
6438 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
6439 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
6440 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
6441
6442 Next, you have to edit a file and
6443 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
6444 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors: GNU nano
6445 (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
6446 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
6447 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
6448 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
6449 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
6450
6451 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
6452 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
6453 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
6454 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
6455 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
6456 something along these lines:
6457
6458 @example
6459 # mkdir /mnt/etc
6460 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
6461 # zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
6462 @end example
6463
6464 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
6465 in particular:
6466
6467 @itemize
6468 @item
6469 Make sure the @code{grub-configuration} form refers to the device you
6470 want to install GRUB on.
6471
6472 @item
6473 Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
6474 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
6475 your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
6476 @code{'label}.
6477 @end itemize
6478
6479 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
6480 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
6481 under @file{/mnt}):
6482
6483 @example
6484 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
6485 @end example
6486
6487 @noindent
6488 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
6489 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6490 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
6491 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
6492
6493 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
6494 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
6495 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
6496 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
6497 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
6498 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
6499
6500 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
6501 @file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
6502 good.
6503
6504 @node Installing GuixSD in a VM
6505 @subsection Installing GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
6506
6507 @cindex virtual machine, GuixSD installation
6508 If you'd like to install GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) rather than on
6509 your beloved machine, this section is for you.
6510
6511 To boot a @uref{http://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing GuixSD in a
6512 disk image, follow these steps:
6513
6514 @enumerate
6515 @item
6516 First, retrieve the GuixSD installation image as described previously
6517 (@pxref{USB Stick Installation}).
6518
6519 @item
6520 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
6521 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
6522
6523 @example
6524 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 5G
6525 @end example
6526
6527 This will create a 5GB file.
6528
6529 @item
6530 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
6531
6532 @example
6533 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 \
6534 -net default -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
6535 -drive file=guixsd.img \
6536 -drive file=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}
6537 @end example
6538
6539 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
6540 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
6541 selection.
6542
6543 @item
6544 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
6545 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
6546 @end enumerate
6547
6548 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
6549 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM}, for how to do
6550 that.
6551
6552 @node Building the Installation Image
6553 @subsection Building the Installation Image
6554
6555 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
6556 system} command, specifically:
6557
6558 @c FIXME: 1G is too much; see <http://bugs.gnu.org/23077>.
6559 @example
6560 guix system disk-image --image-size=1G gnu/system/install.scm
6561 @end example
6562
6563 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
6564 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
6565 about the installation image.
6566
6567 @node System Configuration
6568 @section System Configuration
6569
6570 @cindex system configuration
6571 The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
6572 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
6573 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
6574 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
6575 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
6576
6577 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
6578 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
6579 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
6580 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
6581 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
6582 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
6583 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
6584 the own tools of the system.
6585 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
6586
6587 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
6588 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
6589 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
6590 instance to support new system services.
6591
6592 @menu
6593 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
6594 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
6595 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
6596 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
6597 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
6598 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
6599 * Services:: Specifying system services.
6600 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
6601 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
6602 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
6603 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
6604 * GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
6605 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
6606 * Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
6607 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
6608 @end menu
6609
6610 @node Using the Configuration System
6611 @subsection Using the Configuration System
6612
6613 The operating system is configured by providing an
6614 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
6615 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
6616 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
6617 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
6618
6619 @findex operating-system
6620 @lisp
6621 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
6622 @end lisp
6623
6624 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
6625 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
6626 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
6627 which case they get a default value.
6628
6629 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
6630 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
6631 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
6632 @command{guix system}.
6633
6634 @unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
6635
6636 @vindex %base-packages
6637 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
6638 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
6639 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
6640 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
6641 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
6642 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
6643 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
6644 etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
6645 packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
6646
6647 @findex specification->package
6648 Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
6649 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
6650 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
6651 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
6652 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
6653 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
6654 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
6655 version:
6656
6657 @lisp
6658 (use-modules (gnu packages))
6659
6660 (operating-system
6661 ;; ...
6662 (packages (append (map specification->package
6663 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
6664 %base-packages)))
6665 @end lisp
6666
6667 @unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
6668
6669 @vindex %base-services
6670 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
6671 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
6672 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
6673 addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
6674 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
6675 @code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
6676 @code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
6677 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
6678 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
6679
6680 @cindex customization, of services
6681 @findex modify-services
6682 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
6683 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
6684 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
6685
6686 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
6687 (the console log-in) in the @var{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
6688 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
6689 following in your operating system declaration:
6690
6691 @lisp
6692 (define %my-services
6693 ;; My very own list of services.
6694 (modify-services %base-services
6695 (guix-service-type config =>
6696 (guix-configuration
6697 (inherit config)
6698 (use-substitutes? #f)
6699 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
6700 (mingetty-service-type config =>
6701 (mingetty-configuration
6702 (inherit config)
6703 (motd (plain-file "motd" "Howdy!"))))))
6704
6705 (operating-system
6706 ;; @dots{}
6707 (services %my-services))
6708 @end lisp
6709
6710 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
6711 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
6712 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @var{%base-services} list.
6713 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
6714 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
6715 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
6716 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
6717 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
6718 configuration, but with a few modifications.
6719
6720 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
6721 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
6722 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
6723 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
6724
6725 @lisp
6726 @include os-config-desktop.texi
6727 @end lisp
6728
6729 A graphical environment with a choice of lightweight window managers
6730 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
6731
6732 @lisp
6733 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
6734 @end lisp
6735
6736 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
6737 @var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
6738 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
6739
6740 Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
6741 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
6742 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
6743 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
6744 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
6745 @var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
6746
6747 @example
6748 (remove (lambda (service)
6749 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
6750 %desktop-services)
6751 @end example
6752
6753 @unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
6754
6755 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
6756 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
6757 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
6758 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
6759 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
6760
6761 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
6762 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
6763 have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
6764 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
6765 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
6766 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
6767 system, should you ever need to.
6768
6769 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
6770 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
6771 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
6772 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
6773 an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
6774 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
6775 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
6776 generations available on disk.
6777
6778 @unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
6779
6780 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
6781 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
6782 Monad}):
6783
6784 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
6785 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
6786 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
6787
6788 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
6789 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
6790 instantiate @var{os}.
6791 @end deffn
6792
6793 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
6794 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
6795 guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
6796
6797
6798 @node operating-system Reference
6799 @subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
6800
6801 This section summarizes all the options available in
6802 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
6803 System}).
6804
6805 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
6806 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
6807 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
6808 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
6809
6810 @table @asis
6811 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
6812 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
6813 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
6814 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
6815
6816 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6817 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
6818 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
6819
6820 @item @code{bootloader}
6821 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
6822
6823 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
6824 A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
6825 the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
6826
6827 @item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
6828 @cindex firmware
6829 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
6830
6831 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
6832 (Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for
6833 more info on supported hardware.
6834
6835 @item @code{host-name}
6836 The host name.
6837
6838 @item @code{hosts-file}
6839 @cindex hosts file
6840 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
6841 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6842 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
6843 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
6844
6845 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6846 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
6847
6848 @item @code{file-systems}
6849 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
6850
6851 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6852 @cindex swap devices
6853 A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
6854 (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6855 For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
6856
6857 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
6858 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
6859 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
6860
6861 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
6862 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
6863 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
6864 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
6865
6866 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
6867
6868 @example
6869 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
6870 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
6871 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
6872 (activate-readline)")))
6873 @end example
6874
6875 @item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
6876 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
6877 displayed when users log in on a text console.
6878
6879 @item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
6880 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
6881 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
6882
6883 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
6884 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
6885 package}).
6886
6887 @item @code{timezone}
6888 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
6889
6890 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
6891 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
6892 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
6893
6894 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
6895 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
6896 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
6897
6898 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
6899 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
6900 run time. @xref{Locales}.
6901
6902 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
6903 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
6904 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
6905 considerations that justify this option.
6906
6907 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
6908 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
6909 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
6910 details.
6911
6912 @item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
6913 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
6914
6915 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
6916 @cindex PAM
6917 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
6918 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6919 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6920
6921 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6922 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6923 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
6924
6925 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6926 @cindex sudoers file
6927 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6928 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
6929
6930 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6931 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6932 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6933 @code{sudo}.
6934
6935 @end table
6936 @end deftp
6937
6938 @node File Systems
6939 @subsection File Systems
6940
6941 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6942 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
6943 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6944 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
6945
6946 @example
6947 (file-system
6948 (mount-point "/home")
6949 (device "/dev/sda3")
6950 (type "ext4"))
6951 @end example
6952
6953 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
6954 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
6955
6956 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
6957 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
6958 contain the following members:
6959
6960 @table @asis
6961 @item @code{type}
6962 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
6963 @code{"ext4"}.
6964
6965 @item @code{mount-point}
6966 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
6967
6968 @item @code{device}
6969 This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
6970 of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
6971 field described below.
6972
6973 @item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
6974 This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
6975 interpreted.
6976
6977 When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
6978 interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
6979 is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
6980 @code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
6981
6982 UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
6983 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
6984 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
6985 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
6986 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
6987 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
6988 like this:
6989
6990 @example
6991 (file-system
6992 (mount-point "/home")
6993 (type "ext4")
6994 (title 'uuid)
6995 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
6996 @end example
6997
6998 The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
6999 partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
7000 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
7001 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
7002 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
7003 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
7004 mounted.}.
7005
7006 However, when the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
7007 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
7008 device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
7009 @code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
7010 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
7011 corresponding device mapping established.
7012
7013 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
7014 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
7015 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
7016 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
7017 bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
7018
7019 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
7020 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
7021
7022 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
7023 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
7024 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
7025 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
7026 is not automatically mounted.
7027
7028 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
7029 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
7030 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
7031 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
7032 instance, for the root file system.
7033
7034 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
7035 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
7036 errors before being mounted.
7037
7038 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
7039 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
7040
7041 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
7042 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
7043 that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
7044
7045 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
7046 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
7047 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
7048
7049 @end table
7050 @end deftp
7051
7052 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
7053 variables.
7054
7055 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
7056 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
7057 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
7058 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
7059 these.
7060 @end defvr
7061
7062 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
7063 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
7064 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
7065 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
7066 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
7067 @command{xterm}.
7068 @end defvr
7069
7070 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
7071 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
7072 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
7073 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7074 @end defvr
7075
7076 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
7077 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
7078 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
7079 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
7080 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
7081
7082 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
7083 read-write in its own ``name space.''
7084 @end defvr
7085
7086 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
7087 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
7088 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
7089 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7090 @end defvr
7091
7092 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
7093 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
7094 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
7095 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
7096 @end defvr
7097
7098 @node Mapped Devices
7099 @subsection Mapped Devices
7100
7101 @cindex device mapping
7102 @cindex mapped devices
7103 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
7104 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
7105 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
7106 with additional processing over the data that flows through
7107 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
7108 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
7109 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
7110 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
7111 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
7112 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
7113 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
7114 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
7115 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
7116 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
7117 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
7118 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
7119 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
7120
7121 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
7122 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
7123
7124 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
7125 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
7126 the system boots up.
7127
7128 @table @code
7129 @item source
7130 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
7131 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
7132 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
7133
7134 @item target
7135 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
7136 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
7137 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
7138 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
7139 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
7140 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
7141
7142 @item type
7143 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
7144 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
7145 @end table
7146 @end deftp
7147
7148 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
7149 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
7150 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
7151 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
7152 @end defvr
7153
7154 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
7155 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
7156 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
7157 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
7158 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
7159 @end defvr
7160
7161 @cindex disk encryption
7162 @cindex LUKS
7163 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
7164 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
7165 @url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
7166 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
7167 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
7168 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
7169 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7170
7171 @example
7172 (mapped-device
7173 (source "/dev/sda3")
7174 (target "home")
7175 (type luks-device-mapping))
7176 @end example
7177
7178 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
7179 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
7180 command like:
7181
7182 @example
7183 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
7184 @end example
7185
7186 and use it as follows:
7187
7188 @example
7189 (mapped-device
7190 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
7191 (target "home")
7192 (type luks-device-mapping))
7193 @end example
7194
7195 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
7196 may be declared as follows:
7197
7198 @example
7199 (mapped-device
7200 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
7201 (target "/dev/md0")
7202 (type raid-device-mapping))
7203 @end example
7204
7205 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
7206 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
7207 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
7208 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
7209 automatically later.
7210
7211
7212 @node User Accounts
7213 @subsection User Accounts
7214
7215 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
7216 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
7217 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
7218
7219 @example
7220 (user-account
7221 (name "alice")
7222 (group "users")
7223 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
7224 "audio" ;sound card
7225 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
7226 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
7227 (comment "Bob's sister")
7228 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
7229 @end example
7230
7231 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
7232 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
7233 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
7234 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
7235 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
7236 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
7237 as declared.
7238
7239 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
7240 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
7241 be specified:
7242
7243 @table @asis
7244 @item @code{name}
7245 The name of the user account.
7246
7247 @item @code{group}
7248 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
7249 this account belongs to.
7250
7251 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
7252 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
7253 account belongs to.
7254
7255 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
7256 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
7257 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
7258 account is created.
7259
7260 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
7261 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
7262
7263 @item @code{home-directory}
7264 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
7265
7266 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
7267 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
7268 if it does not exist yet.
7269
7270 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
7271 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
7272 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7273
7274 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7275 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
7276 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
7277 graphical login managers do not list them.
7278
7279 @anchor{user-account-password}
7280 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7281 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
7282 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
7283 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
7284 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
7285 reconfiguration.
7286
7287 If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
7288 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
7289 @xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
7290 on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
7291 Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
7292
7293 @end table
7294 @end deftp
7295
7296 User group declarations are even simpler:
7297
7298 @example
7299 (user-group (name "students"))
7300 @end example
7301
7302 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
7303 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
7304
7305 @table @asis
7306 @item @code{name}
7307 The name of the group.
7308
7309 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
7310 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
7311 automatically allocated when the group is created.
7312
7313 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
7314 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
7315 System groups have low numerical IDs.
7316
7317 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
7318 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
7319 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
7320
7321 @end table
7322 @end deftp
7323
7324 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
7325 expect:
7326
7327 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
7328 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
7329 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
7330 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
7331 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
7332 @end defvr
7333
7334 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
7335 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
7336 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
7337
7338 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
7339 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
7340 @end defvr
7341
7342 @node Locales
7343 @subsection Locales
7344
7345 @cindex locale
7346 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
7347 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7348 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
7349 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
7350 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
7351 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
7352
7353 @cindex locale definition
7354 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
7355 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
7356 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
7357
7358 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
7359 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
7360 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
7361 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
7362 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
7363 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
7364 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
7365 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
7366
7367 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
7368 that field may be:
7369
7370 @example
7371 (cons (locale-definition
7372 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
7373 %default-locale-definitions)
7374 @end example
7375
7376 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
7377 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
7378
7379 @example
7380 (list (locale-definition
7381 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
7382 (charset "EUC-JP")))
7383 @end example
7384
7385 @vindex LOCPATH
7386 The compiled locale definitions are available at
7387 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
7388 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
7389 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
7390 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7391 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7392
7393 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
7394 locale)} module. Details are given below.
7395
7396 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
7397 This is the data type of a locale definition.
7398
7399 @table @asis
7400
7401 @item @code{name}
7402 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
7403 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
7404
7405 @item @code{source}
7406 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
7407 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
7408
7409 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
7410 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
7411 @uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
7412 IANA}.
7413
7414 @end table
7415 @end deftp
7416
7417 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
7418 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
7419 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
7420 declarations.
7421
7422 @cindex locale name
7423 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
7424 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
7425 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
7426 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
7427 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
7428 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
7429 @end defvr
7430
7431 @subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
7432
7433 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
7434 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
7435 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
7436 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
7437 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
7438 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
7439 another.
7440
7441 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
7442 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
7443 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
7444 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
7445 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
7446 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
7447 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
7448 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
7449 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
7450 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
7451 programs will not abort.
7452
7453 The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
7454 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
7455 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
7456 used to build the system-wide locale data.
7457
7458 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
7459 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
7460 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
7461
7462 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
7463 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
7464 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
7465 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
7466 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
7467 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
7468
7469 @example
7470 (use-package-modules base)
7471
7472 (operating-system
7473 ;; @dots{}
7474 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
7475 @end example
7476
7477 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
7478 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
7479 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
7480
7481
7482 @node Services
7483 @subsection Services
7484
7485 @cindex system services
7486 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
7487 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
7488 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
7489 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
7490 configuring network access.
7491
7492 GuixSD has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
7493 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
7494 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
7495 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
7496 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
7497 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
7498
7499 @example
7500 # herd status
7501 @end example
7502
7503 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
7504 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
7505 service:
7506
7507 @example
7508 # herd doc nscd
7509 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
7510 @end example
7511
7512 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
7513 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
7514 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
7515
7516 @example
7517 # herd stop nscd
7518 Service nscd has been stopped.
7519 # herd restart xorg-server
7520 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
7521 Service xorg-server has been started.
7522 @end example
7523
7524 The following sections document the available services, starting with
7525 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
7526 declaration.
7527
7528 @menu
7529 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
7530 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
7531 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
7532 * X Window:: Graphical display.
7533 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
7534 * Database Services:: SQL databases.
7535 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
7536 * Web Services:: Web servers.
7537 * Various Services:: Other services.
7538 @end menu
7539
7540 @node Base Services
7541 @subsubsection Base Services
7542
7543 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
7544 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
7545 this module are listed below.
7546
7547 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
7548 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
7549 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
7550 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
7551 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
7552 more.
7553
7554 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
7555 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
7556 system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
7557 this:
7558
7559 @example
7560 (cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
7561 @end example
7562 @end defvr
7563
7564 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
7565 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
7566 @end deffn
7567
7568 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
7569 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
7570 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
7571 other things.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
7575 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
7576 implements console log-in.
7577
7578 @table @asis
7579
7580 @item @code{tty}
7581 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
7582
7583 @item @code{motd}
7584 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
7585
7586 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
7587 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
7588 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
7589 user name and password must be entered to log in.
7590
7591 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
7592 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
7593 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
7594 the name of the log-in program.
7595
7596 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
7597 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
7598 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
7599
7600 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
7601 The Mingetty package to use.
7602
7603 @end table
7604 @end deftp
7605
7606 @cindex name service cache daemon
7607 @cindex nscd
7608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
7609 [#:name-services '()]
7610 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
7611 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
7612 Service Switch}, for an example.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
7616 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
7617 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
7618 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
7619 @end defvr
7620
7621 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
7622 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
7623 configuration.
7624
7625 @table @asis
7626
7627 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
7628 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
7629 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
7630
7631 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
7632 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
7633 command.
7634
7635 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
7636 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
7637 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
7638
7639 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
7640 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
7641 debugging output is logged.
7642
7643 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
7644 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
7645 below.
7646
7647 @end table
7648 @end deftp
7649
7650 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
7651 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
7652
7653 @table @asis
7654
7655 @item @code{database}
7656 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
7657 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
7658 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
7659 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
7660
7661 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
7662 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
7663 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
7664 negative lookup result remains in cache.
7665
7666 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
7667 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
7668 @var{database}.
7669
7670 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
7671 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
7672 them into account.
7673
7674 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
7675 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
7676
7677 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
7678 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
7679
7680 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
7681 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
7682
7683 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
7684 @c settings, so leave them out.
7685
7686 @end table
7687 @end deftp
7688
7689 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
7690 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
7691 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
7692
7693 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
7694 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
7695 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
7696 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
7697 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
7698 @end defvr
7699
7700
7701 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @
7702 [#:config-file @var{%default-syslog.conf}]
7703 Return a service that runs @command{syslogd}. If the configuration file
7704 name @var{config-file} is not specified, use some reasonable default
7705 settings.
7706
7707 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
7708 information on the configuration file syntax.
7709 @end deffn
7710
7711 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
7712 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
7713 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
7714 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
7715
7716 @table @asis
7717 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
7718 The Guix package to use.
7719
7720 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
7721 Name of the group for build user accounts.
7722
7723 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
7724 Number of build user accounts to create.
7725
7726 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
7727 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
7728 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{hydra.gnu.org}
7729 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7730
7731 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
7732 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @var{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
7733 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
7734 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
7735 contains that of @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7736
7737 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
7738 Whether to use substitutes.
7739
7740 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
7741 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
7742
7743 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
7744 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
7745
7746 @item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
7747 @itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
7748 The lsof and lsh packages to use.
7749
7750 @end table
7751 @end deftp
7752
7753 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
7754 Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
7755 @var{config}.
7756 @end deffn
7757
7758 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
7759 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
7760 @end deffn
7761
7762 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} urandom-seed-service @var{#f}
7763 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
7764 when rebooting.
7765 @end deffn
7766
7767 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
7768 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
7769 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
7770 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
7771 @end defvr
7772
7773 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{files} ...
7774 @cindex keyboard layout
7775 Return a service to load console keymaps from @var{files} using
7776 @command{loadkeys} command. Most likely, you want to load some default
7777 keymap, which can be done like this:
7778
7779 @example
7780 (console-keymap-service "dvorak")
7781 @end example
7782
7783 Or, for example, for a Swedish keyboard, you may need to combine
7784 the following keymaps:
7785 @example
7786 (console-keymap-service "se-lat6" "se-fi-lat6")
7787 @end example
7788
7789 Also you can specify a full file name (or file names) of your keymap(s).
7790 See @code{man loadkeys} for details.
7791
7792 @end deffn
7793
7794 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
7795 [#:options]
7796 Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
7797 command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
7798 notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
7799 uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
7800
7801 This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
7802 @end deffn
7803
7804 @anchor{guix-publish-service}
7805 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
7806 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
7807 Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
7808 and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
7809
7810 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
7811 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
7812 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
7813 @end deffn
7814
7815 @anchor{rngd-service}
7816 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
7817 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
7818 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
7819 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
7820 @var{device} does not exist.
7821 @end deffn
7822
7823 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
7824 @cindex session limits
7825 @cindex ulimit
7826 @cindex priority
7827 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @var{limits}]
7828
7829 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
7830 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
7831 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
7832 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
7833 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
7834
7835 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
7836 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
7837
7838 @example
7839 (pam-limits-service
7840 (list
7841 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
7842 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
7843 @end example
7844
7845 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
7846 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
7847 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
7848 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
7849 @end deffn
7850
7851 @node Scheduled Job Execution
7852 @subsubsection Scheduled Job Execution
7853
7854 @cindex cron
7855 @cindex scheduling jobs
7856 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
7857 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
7858 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
7859 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
7860 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
7861 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
7862
7863 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
7864 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
7865 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
7866 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
7867 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
7868 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
7869 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
7870
7871 @lisp
7872 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
7873 (use-package-modules base idutils)
7874
7875 (define updatedb-job
7876 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
7877 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
7878 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
7879 (lambda ()
7880 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
7881 "updatedb"
7882 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
7883
7884 (define garbage-collector-job
7885 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
7886 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
7887 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
7888 "guix gc -F 1G"))
7889
7890 (define idutils-job
7891 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
7892 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
7893 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
7894 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
7895 #:user "charlie"))
7896
7897 (operating-system
7898 ;; @dots{}
7899 (services (cons (mcron-service (list garbage-collector-job
7900 updatedb-job
7901 idutils-job))
7902 %base-services)))
7903 @end lisp
7904
7905 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
7906 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
7907 reference of the mcron service.
7908
7909 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mcron-service @var{jobs} [#:mcron @var{mcron2}]
7910 Return an mcron service running @var{mcron} that schedules @var{jobs}, a
7911 list of gexps denoting mcron job specifications.
7912
7913 This is a shorthand for:
7914 @example
7915 (service mcron-service-type
7916 (mcron-configuration (mcron mcron) (jobs jobs)))
7917 @end example
7918 @end deffn
7919
7920 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
7921 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
7922 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
7923
7924 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
7925 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
7926 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
7927 mcron jobs to run.
7928 @end defvr
7929
7930 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
7931 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
7932
7933 @table @asis
7934 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron2})
7935 The mcron package to use.
7936
7937 @item @code{jobs}
7938 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
7939 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
7940 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
7941 @end table
7942 @end deftp
7943
7944
7945 @node Networking Services
7946 @subsubsection Networking Services
7947
7948 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
7949 the network interface.
7950
7951 @cindex DHCP, networking service
7952 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
7953 Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
7954 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
7958 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}]
7959 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
7960 @var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
7961 gateway.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @cindex wicd
7965 @cindex network management
7966 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
7967 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
7968 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
7969
7970 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
7971 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
7972 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
7973 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @cindex NetworkManager
7977 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
7978 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
7979 Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
7980 attempting to keep network connectivity active when available.
7981 @end deffn
7982
7983 @cindex Connman
7984 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} connman-service @
7985 [#:connman @var{connman}]
7986 Return a service that runs @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman}, a network
7987 connection manager.
7988
7989 This service adds the @var{connman} package to the global profile, providing
7990 several the @command{connmanctl} command to interact with the daemon and
7991 configure networking."
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
7995 [#:servers @var{%ntp-servers}]
7996 Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
7997 @uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
7998 keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
7999 @end deffn
8000
8001 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
8002 List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
8003 @end defvr
8004
8005 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
8006 Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
8007 networking daemon.
8008
8009 The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
8010 @var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
8011 and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
8012 @command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
8013 @end deffn
8014
8015 @cindex hidden service
8016 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
8017 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
8018 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
8019
8020 @example
8021 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
8022 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
8023 @end example
8024
8025 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
8026 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
8027
8028 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
8029 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
8030 service.
8031
8032 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
8033 project's documentation} for more information.
8034 @end deffn
8035
8036 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
8037 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
8038 [#:extra-settings ""]
8039 Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
8040 acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
8041
8042 The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
8043 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
8044 local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
8045 come from any networking interface.
8046
8047 In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
8048 configuration file.
8049 @end deffn
8050
8051 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
8052
8053 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
8054 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
8055 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
8056 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
8057 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
8058 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
8059 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
8060 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
8061 only by root.
8062
8063 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
8064 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
8065 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
8066 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
8067 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
8068
8069 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
8070 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
8071 require interaction.
8072
8073 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
8074 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
8075 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
8076 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
8077
8078 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
8079 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
8080 or addresses.
8081
8082 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
8083 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
8084 root.
8085
8086 The other options should be self-descriptive.
8087 @end deffn
8088
8089 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
8090 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
8091 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
8092 object.
8093
8094 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
8095 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
8096
8097 @example
8098 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
8099 (port-number 1234)))
8100 @end example
8101 @end deffn
8102
8103 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
8104 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
8105
8106 @table @asis
8107 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
8108 The Dropbear package to use.
8109
8110 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
8111 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
8112
8113 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
8114 Whether to enable syslog output.
8115
8116 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
8117 File name of the daemon's PID file.
8118
8119 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
8120 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
8121
8122 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
8123 Whether to allow empty passwords.
8124
8125 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
8126 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
8127 @end table
8128 @end deftp
8129
8130 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
8131 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
8132 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
8133 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
8134 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
8135 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
8136
8137 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
8138 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
8139 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
8140
8141 @example
8142 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
8143
8144 (operating-system
8145 (host-name "mymachine")
8146 ;; ...
8147 (hosts-file
8148 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
8149 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
8150 (plain-file "hosts"
8151 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
8152 %facebook-host-aliases))))
8153 @end example
8154
8155 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
8156 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
8157 @end defvr
8158
8159 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
8160
8161 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
8162 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
8163 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
8164 [#:domains-to-browse '()] [#:debug? #f]
8165 Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
8166 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
8167 "zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
8168 extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
8169 @code{.local} host names using
8170 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
8171 add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
8172 @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
8173
8174 If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
8175 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
8176
8177 When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
8178 in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
8179 address via mDNS on the local network.
8180
8181 When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
8182
8183 Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
8184 sockets.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187
8188 @node X Window
8189 @subsubsection X Window
8190
8191 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
8192 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
8193 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
8194 started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
8195
8196 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
8197 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
8198 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
8199 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
8200 Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
8201 turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
8202 @code{xorg-start-command}.
8203
8204 @cindex X session
8205
8206 SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
8207 files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
8208 to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
8209 @var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
8210 adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
8211 available at the log-in screen.
8212
8213 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
8214 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
8215 and/or other X clients.
8216
8217 When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
8218 password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
8219 @var{default-user}.
8220
8221 If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, use the default log-in theme; otherwise
8222 @var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
8223 theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
8224 theme.
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
8228 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
8229 The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
8230 @end defvr
8231
8232 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
8233 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
8234 Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
8235 from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
8236 file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
8237 @code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
8238
8239 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
8243 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
8244 Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
8245 all the common drivers.
8246
8247 @var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
8248 graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
8249 this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
8250
8251 Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
8252 appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
8253 resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
8254
8255 Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
8256 @code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
8257 verbatim to the configuration file.
8258 @end deffn
8259
8260 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
8261 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
8262 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
8263 for it. For example:
8264
8265 @lisp
8266 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
8267 @end lisp
8268
8269 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
8270 @end deffn
8271
8272
8273 @node Desktop Services
8274 @subsubsection Desktop Services
8275
8276 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
8277 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
8278 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
8279 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
8280 environments like GNOME and XFCE.
8281
8282 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
8283 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
8284 environment and networking:
8285
8286 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
8287 This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
8288 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
8289
8290 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
8291 @code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
8292 a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
8293 Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
8294 the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
8295 the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
8296 Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
8297 configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
8298 Switch, mDNS}).
8299 @end defvr
8300
8301 The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
8302 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
8303 Reference, @code{services}}).
8304
8305 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service} and
8306 @code{xfce-desktop-service} procedures can add GNOME and/or XFCE to a
8307 system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level services like the
8308 backlight adjustment helpers and the power management utilities are
8309 added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
8310 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
8311 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
8312 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service} adds the GNOME
8313 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the XFCE service
8314 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
8315 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
8316 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
8317 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
8318
8319 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gnome-desktop-service
8320 Return a service that adds the @code{gnome} package to the system
8321 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
8322 @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
8323 @end deffn
8324
8325 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xfce-desktop-service
8326 Return a service that adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile,
8327 and extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the
8328 file system as root from within a user session, after the user has
8329 authenticated with the administrator's password.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 Because the GNOME and XFCE desktop services pull in so many packages,
8333 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include either of
8334 them by default. To add GNOME or XFCE, just @code{cons} them onto
8335 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
8336 @code{operating-system}:
8337
8338 @example
8339 (use-modules (gnu))
8340 (use-service-modules desktop)
8341 (operating-system
8342 ...
8343 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
8344 (services (cons* (gnome-desktop-service)
8345 (xfce-desktop-service)
8346 %desktop-services))
8347 ...)
8348 @end example
8349
8350 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
8351 graphical login window.
8352
8353 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
8354 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
8355 are described below.
8356
8357 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
8358 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
8359 support for @var{services}.
8360
8361 @uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
8362 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
8363 and to be notified of system-wide events.
8364
8365 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
8366 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
8367 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
8368 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
8369 @end deffn
8370
8371 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
8372 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
8373 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
8374 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
8375 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
8376 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
8377
8378 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
8379 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
8380 when the power button is pressed.
8381
8382 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
8383 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
8384 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
8385 their default values are:
8386
8387 @table @code
8388 @item kill-user-processes?
8389 @code{#f}
8390 @item kill-only-users
8391 @code{()}
8392 @item kill-exclude-users
8393 @code{("root")}
8394 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
8395 @code{5}
8396 @item handle-power-key
8397 @code{poweroff}
8398 @item handle-suspend-key
8399 @code{suspend}
8400 @item handle-hibernate-key
8401 @code{hibernate}
8402 @item handle-lid-switch
8403 @code{suspend}
8404 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
8405 @code{ignore}
8406 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
8407 @code{#f}
8408 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
8409 @code{#f}
8410 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
8411 @code{#f}
8412 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
8413 @code{#t}
8414 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
8415 @code{30}
8416 @item idle-action
8417 @code{ignore}
8418 @item idle-action-seconds
8419 @code{(* 30 60)}
8420 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
8421 @code{10}
8422 @item runtime-directory-size
8423 @code{#f}
8424 @item remove-ipc?
8425 @code{#t}
8426 @item suspend-state
8427 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
8428 @item suspend-mode
8429 @code{()}
8430 @item hibernate-state
8431 @code{("disk")}
8432 @item hibernate-mode
8433 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
8434 @item hybrid-sleep-state
8435 @code{("disk")}
8436 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
8437 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
8438 @end table
8439 @end deffn
8440
8441 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
8442 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
8443 Return a service that runs the
8444 @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
8445 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
8446 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
8447 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
8448 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
8449 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
8450 @end deffn
8451
8452 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
8453 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
8454 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
8455 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
8456 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
8457 [#:percentage-low 10] @
8458 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
8459 [#:percentage-action 2] @
8460 [#:time-low 1200] @
8461 [#:time-critical 300] @
8462 [#:time-action 120] @
8463 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
8464 Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
8465 @command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
8466 levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
8467 @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
8468 GNOME.
8469 @end deffn
8470
8471 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
8472 Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
8473 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
8474 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
8475 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
8476 @end deffn
8477
8478 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
8479 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
8480 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
8481 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
8482 tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
8483 site} for more information.
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
8487 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
8488 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
8489 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
8490 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
8491 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
8492 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
8493 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
8494 means that all users are allowed.
8495 @end deffn
8496
8497 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
8498 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
8499 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
8500 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
8501 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
8502 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
8503 know the user's location.
8504 @end defvr
8505
8506 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
8507 [#:whitelist '()] @
8508 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
8509 [#:submit-data? #f]
8510 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
8511 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
8512 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
8513 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
8514 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
8515 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
8516 location databases. See
8517 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
8518 web site} for more information.
8519 @end deffn
8520
8521 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}]
8522 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which manages
8523 all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus interfaces.
8524
8525 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
8526 @end deffn
8527
8528 @node Database Services
8529 @subsubsection Database Services
8530
8531 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
8532
8533 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
8534 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
8535 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
8536 server.
8537
8538 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
8539 @var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
8540 @var{data-directory}.
8541 @end deffn
8542
8543 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
8544 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
8545 database server.
8546
8547 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
8548 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuraiton>} object.
8549 @end deffn
8550
8551 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
8552 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
8553
8554 @table @asis
8555 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
8556 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
8557 or @var{mysql}.
8558
8559 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
8560 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
8561 @end table
8562 @end deftp
8563
8564 @node Mail Services
8565 @subsubsection Mail Services
8566
8567 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
8568 for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
8569 an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
8570
8571 Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
8572 lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
8573 is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
8574 welcome!
8575
8576 To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
8577 @code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
8578
8579 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
8580 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
8581 @end deffn
8582
8583 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
8584 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
8585 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
8586 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
8587 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
8588 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
8589 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
8590 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
8591
8592 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
8593 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
8594
8595 @example
8596 (dovecot-service #:config
8597 (dovecot-configuration
8598 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
8599 @end example
8600
8601 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
8602 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
8603 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
8604 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
8605 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
8606 from some other system; see the end for more details.
8607
8608 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
8609 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
8610 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
8611 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
8612 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
8613 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
8614 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
8615
8616 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8617
8618 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8619 The dovecot package.
8620 @end deftypevr
8621
8622 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
8623 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
8624 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
8625 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
8626 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
8627 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
8628 @end deftypevr
8629
8630 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
8631 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
8632 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
8633
8634 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
8635
8636 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
8637 The name of the protocol.
8638 @end deftypevr
8639
8640 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
8641 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
8642 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8643 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8644 @end deftypevr
8645
8646 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8647 Space separated list of plugins to load.
8648 @end deftypevr
8649
8650 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
8651 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
8652 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
8653 Defaults to @samp{10}.
8654 @end deftypevr
8655
8656 @end deftypevr
8657
8658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
8659 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
8660 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
8661 @samp{lmtp}.
8662
8663 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
8664
8665 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
8666 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
8667 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
8668 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
8669 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
8670 @end deftypevr
8671
8672 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
8673 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
8674 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
8675 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
8676 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8677
8678 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
8679
8680 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
8681 The file name on which to listen.
8682 @end deftypevr
8683
8684 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
8685 The access mode for the socket.
8686 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
8687 @end deftypevr
8688
8689 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
8690 The user to own the socket.
8691 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8692 @end deftypevr
8693
8694 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
8695 The group to own the socket.
8696 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8697 @end deftypevr
8698
8699
8700 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
8701
8702 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
8703 The file name on which to listen.
8704 @end deftypevr
8705
8706 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
8707 The access mode for the socket.
8708 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
8709 @end deftypevr
8710
8711 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
8712 The user to own the socket.
8713 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8714 @end deftypevr
8715
8716 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
8717 The group to own the socket.
8718 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8719 @end deftypevr
8720
8721
8722 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
8723
8724 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
8725 The protocol to listen for.
8726 @end deftypevr
8727
8728 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
8729 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
8730 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8731 @end deftypevr
8732
8733 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
8734 The port on which to listen.
8735 @end deftypevr
8736
8737 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
8738 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
8739 @samp{required}.
8740 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8741 @end deftypevr
8742
8743 @end deftypevr
8744
8745 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
8746 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
8747 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
8748 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
8749 Defaults to @samp{1}.
8750 @end deftypevr
8751
8752 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
8753 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
8754 Defaults to @samp{0}.
8755 @end deftypevr
8756
8757 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
8758 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
8759 this.
8760 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8761 @end deftypevr
8762
8763 @end deftypevr
8764
8765 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
8766 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
8767 constructor.
8768
8769 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
8770
8771 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
8772 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
8773 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8774 @end deftypevr
8775
8776 @end deftypevr
8777
8778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
8779 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
8780 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
8781
8782 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
8783
8784 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
8785 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
8786 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
8787 @samp{static}.
8788 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
8789 @end deftypevr
8790
8791 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
8792 A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
8793 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8794 @end deftypevr
8795
8796 @end deftypevr
8797
8798 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
8799 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
8800 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
8801
8802 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
8803
8804 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
8805 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
8806 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
8807 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
8808 @end deftypevr
8809
8810 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
8811 A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
8812 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8813 @end deftypevr
8814
8815 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
8816 Override fields from passwd.
8817 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8818 @end deftypevr
8819
8820 @end deftypevr
8821
8822 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
8823 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
8824 constructor.
8825 @end deftypevr
8826
8827 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
8828 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
8829 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
8830
8831 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
8832
8833 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
8834 Name for this namespace.
8835 @end deftypevr
8836
8837 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
8838 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
8839 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
8840 @end deftypevr
8841
8842 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
8843 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
8844 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
8845 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
8846 format.
8847 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8848 @end deftypevr
8849
8850 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
8851 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
8852 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
8853 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8854 @end deftypevr
8855
8856 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
8857 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
8858 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
8859 Defaults to @samp{""}.
8860 @end deftypevr
8861
8862 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
8863 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
8864 namespace has it.
8865 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8866 @end deftypevr
8867
8868 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
8869 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
8870 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
8871 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
8872 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
8873 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
8874 and @samp{mail/}.
8875 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8876 @end deftypevr
8877
8878 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
8879 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
8880 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
8881 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
8882 hides the namespace prefix.
8883 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8884 @end deftypevr
8885
8886 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
8887 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
8888 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
8889 as @code{#t}).
8890 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8891 @end deftypevr
8892
8893 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
8894 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
8895 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8896
8897 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
8898
8899 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
8900 Name for this mailbox.
8901 @end deftypevr
8902
8903 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
8904 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
8905 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
8906 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
8907 @end deftypevr
8908
8909 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
8910 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
8911 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
8912 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
8913 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8914 @end deftypevr
8915
8916 @end deftypevr
8917
8918 @end deftypevr
8919
8920 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
8921 Base directory where to store runtime data.
8922 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
8923 @end deftypevr
8924
8925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
8926 Greeting message for clients.
8927 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
8928 @end deftypevr
8929
8930 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
8931 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
8932 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
8933 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
8934 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
8935 here.
8936 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8937 @end deftypevr
8938
8939 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
8940 List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
8941 Defaults to @samp{()}.
8942 @end deftypevr
8943
8944 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
8945 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
8946 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
8947 processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
8948 accounts).
8949 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8950 @end deftypevr
8951
8952 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
8953 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
8954 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
8955 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
8956 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. due to a security fix).
8957 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8958 @end deftypevr
8959
8960 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
8961 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
8962 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
8963 Defaults to @samp{0}.
8964 @end deftypevr
8965
8966 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
8967 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
8968 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
8969 @end deftypevr
8970
8971 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
8972 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
8973 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
8974 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
8975 @end deftypevr
8976
8977 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
8978 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
8979 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
8980 matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
8981 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
8982 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
8983 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8984 @end deftypevr
8985
8986 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
8987 Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
8988 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
8989 for caching to be used.
8990 Defaults to @samp{0}.
8991 @end deftypevr
8992
8993 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
8994 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
8995 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
8996 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
8997 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
8998 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
8999 authentication.
9000 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
9001 @end deftypevr
9002
9003 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
9004 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
9005 0 disables caching them completely.
9006 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
9007 @end deftypevr
9008
9009 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
9010 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
9011 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
9012 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
9013 realm first.
9014 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9015 @end deftypevr
9016
9017 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
9018 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
9019 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
9020 logins.
9021 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9022 @end deftypevr
9023
9024 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
9025 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
9026 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
9027 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
9028 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
9029 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
9030 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
9031 @end deftypevr
9032
9033 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
9034 Username character translations before it's looked up from
9035 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
9036 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
9037 translated to @samp{@@}.
9038 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9039 @end deftypevr
9040
9041 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
9042 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
9043 use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
9044 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
9045 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
9046 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
9047 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
9048 @end deftypevr
9049
9050 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
9051 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
9052 username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
9053 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
9054 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
9055 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
9056 choice.
9057 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9058 @end deftypevr
9059
9060 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
9061 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
9062 mechanism.
9063 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
9064 @end deftypevr
9065
9066 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
9067 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
9068 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
9069 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
9070 Defaults to @samp{30}.
9071 @end deftypevr
9072
9073 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
9074 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
9075 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
9076 allow all keytab entries.
9077 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9078 @end deftypevr
9079
9080 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
9081 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
9082 system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
9083 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
9084 file.
9085 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9086 @end deftypevr
9087
9088 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
9089 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
9090 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
9091 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
9092 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9093 @end deftypevr
9094
9095 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
9096 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
9097 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
9098 @end deftypevr
9099
9100 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
9101 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
9102 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
9103 @end deftypevr
9104
9105 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
9106 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
9107 fails.
9108 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9109 @end deftypevr
9110
9111 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
9112 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
9113 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
9114 CommonName.
9115 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9116 @end deftypevr
9117
9118 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
9119 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
9120 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
9121 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
9122 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
9123 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
9124 @end deftypevr
9125
9126 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
9127 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
9128 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
9129 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
9130 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9131 @end deftypevr
9132
9133 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
9134 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
9135 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
9136 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9137 @end deftypevr
9138
9139 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
9140 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
9141 has any connections.
9142 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
9143 @end deftypevr
9144
9145 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
9146 TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
9147 connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
9148 @samp{inet-listener} for the port.
9149 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9150 @end deftypevr
9151
9152 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
9153 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
9154 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
9155 are shared within domain.
9156 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
9157 @end deftypevr
9158
9159 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
9160 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
9161 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
9162 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
9163 @end deftypevr
9164
9165 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
9166 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
9167 @samp{log-path}.
9168 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9169 @end deftypevr
9170
9171 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
9172 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
9173 @samp{info-log-path}.
9174 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9175 @end deftypevr
9176
9177 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
9178 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
9179 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
9180 standard facilities are supported.
9181 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
9182 @end deftypevr
9183
9184 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
9185 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
9186 failed.
9187 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9188 @end deftypevr
9189
9190 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
9191 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
9192 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
9193 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
9194 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
9195 ":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
9196 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9197 @end deftypevr
9198
9199 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
9200 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
9201 SQL queries.
9202 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9203 @end deftypevr
9204
9205 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
9206 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
9207 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
9208 @samp{auth-debug}.
9209 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9210 @end deftypevr
9211
9212 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
9213 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
9214 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
9215 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9216 @end deftypevr
9217
9218 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
9219 Show protocol level SSL errors.
9220 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9221 @end deftypevr
9222
9223 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
9224 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
9225 strftime(3) format.
9226 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
9227 @end deftypevr
9228
9229 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
9230 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
9231 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
9232 string.
9233 @end deftypevr
9234
9235 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
9236 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
9237 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
9238 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
9239 @end deftypevr
9240
9241 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
9242 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
9243 of possible variables you can use.
9244 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
9245 @end deftypevr
9246
9247 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
9248 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
9249 @table @code
9250 @item %$
9251 Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
9252 @item %m
9253 Message-ID
9254 @item %s
9255 Subject
9256 @item %f
9257 From address
9258 @item %p
9259 Physical size
9260 @item %w
9261 Virtual size.
9262 @end table
9263 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
9264 @end deftypevr
9265
9266 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
9267 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
9268 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
9269 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
9270 Dovecot the full location.
9271
9272 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
9273 file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
9274 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
9275 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
9276 @samp{mail-location} setting.
9277
9278 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
9279
9280 @table @samp
9281 @item %u
9282 username
9283 @item %n
9284 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
9285 @item %d
9286 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
9287 @item %h
9288 home director
9289 @end table
9290
9291 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
9292 @table @samp
9293 @item maildir:~/Maildir
9294 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
9295 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
9296 @end table
9297 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9298 @end deftypevr
9299
9300 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
9301 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
9302 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
9303 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
9304 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9305 @end deftypevr
9306
9307 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
9308
9309 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9310 @end deftypevr
9311
9312 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
9313 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
9314 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
9315 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
9316 /var/mail.
9317 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9318 @end deftypevr
9319
9320 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
9321 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
9322 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
9323 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
9324 symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
9325 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
9326 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
9327 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9328 @end deftypevr
9329
9330 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
9331 Allow full filesystem access to clients. There's no access checks
9332 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
9333 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
9334 names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
9335 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9336 @end deftypevr
9337
9338 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
9339 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
9340 shared filesystems (NFS or clustered filesystem).
9341 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9342 @end deftypevr
9343
9344 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
9345 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
9346 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
9347 nowadays by default.
9348 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9349 @end deftypevr
9350
9351 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
9352 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
9353 @table @code
9354 @item optimized
9355 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
9356 @item always
9357 Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
9358 @item never
9359 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
9360 @end table
9361 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
9362 @end deftypevr
9363
9364 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
9365 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
9366 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
9367 this isn't needed.
9368 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9369 @end deftypevr
9370
9371 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
9372 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
9373 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
9374 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9375 @end deftypevr
9376
9377 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
9378 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
9379 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
9380 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
9381 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
9382 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
9383 @end deftypevr
9384
9385 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
9386 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
9387 kB.
9388 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
9389 @end deftypevr
9390
9391 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
9392 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
9393 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
9394 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
9395 is set to 0.
9396 Defaults to @samp{500}.
9397 @end deftypevr
9398
9399 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
9400
9401 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9402 @end deftypevr
9403
9404 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
9405 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
9406 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
9407 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
9408 Defaults to @samp{1}.
9409 @end deftypevr
9410
9411 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
9412
9413 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9414 @end deftypevr
9415
9416 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
9417 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
9418 trying to create new keywords.
9419 Defaults to @samp{50}.
9420 @end deftypevr
9421
9422 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
9423 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
9424 processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
9425 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
9426 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
9427 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
9428 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
9429 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
9430 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
9431 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9432 @end deftypevr
9433
9434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
9435 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
9436 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
9437 directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
9438 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
9439 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
9440 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
9441 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
9442 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9443 @end deftypevr
9444
9445 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
9446 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
9447 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
9448 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
9449 @end deftypevr
9450
9451 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
9452 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
9453 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
9454 @end deftypevr
9455
9456 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
9457 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
9458 LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
9459 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9460 @end deftypevr
9461
9462 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
9463 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
9464 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
9465 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
9466 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9467 @end deftypevr
9468
9469 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
9470 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
9471 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
9472 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
9473 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
9474 occur.
9475 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
9476 @end deftypevr
9477
9478 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
9479 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
9480 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
9481 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
9482 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
9483 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
9484 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9485 @end deftypevr
9486
9487 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
9488 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
9489 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
9490 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
9491 causes more disk I/O.
9492 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
9493 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
9494 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9495 @end deftypevr
9496
9497 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
9498 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
9499 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
9500 side effects.
9501 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9502 @end deftypevr
9503
9504 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
9505 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
9506 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
9507 the mail otherwise.
9508 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9509 @end deftypevr
9510
9511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
9512 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
9513 available:
9514
9515 @table @code
9516 @item dotlock
9517 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
9518 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
9519 need write access to that directory.
9520 @item dotlock-try
9521 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
9522 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
9523 @item fcntl
9524 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
9525 @item flock
9526 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
9527 @item lockf
9528 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
9529 @end table
9530
9531 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
9532 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
9533 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
9534 them simultaneously.
9535 @end deftypevr
9536
9537 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
9538
9539 @end deftypevr
9540
9541 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
9542 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
9543 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
9544 @end deftypevr
9545
9546 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
9547 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
9548 override the lock file after this much time.
9549 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
9550 @end deftypevr
9551
9552 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
9553 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
9554 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
9555 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
9556 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
9557 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
9558 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
9559 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
9560 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
9561 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
9562 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9563 @end deftypevr
9564
9565 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
9566 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
9567 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
9568 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
9569 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9570 @end deftypevr
9571
9572 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
9573 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
9574 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
9575 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
9576 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
9577 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9578 @end deftypevr
9579
9580 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
9581 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
9582 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
9583 updated.
9584 Defaults to @samp{0}.
9585 @end deftypevr
9586
9587 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
9588 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
9589 Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
9590 @end deftypevr
9591
9592 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
9593 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
9594 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
9595 disabled.
9596 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
9597 @end deftypevr
9598
9599 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
9600 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
9601 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
9602 with some filesystems (ext4, xfs).
9603 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9604 @end deftypevr
9605
9606 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
9607 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
9608 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
9609 don't support this for now.
9610
9611 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
9612
9613 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
9614 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9615 @end deftypevr
9616
9617 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
9618 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
9619 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
9620 externally.
9621 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
9622 @end deftypevr
9623
9624 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
9625 Filesystem backend to use for saving attachments:
9626 @table @code
9627 @item posix
9628 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
9629 @item sis posix
9630 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
9631 @item sis-queue posix
9632 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
9633 @end table
9634 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
9635 @end deftypevr
9636
9637 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
9638 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
9639 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
9640 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
9641 truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
9642 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
9643 @end deftypevr
9644
9645 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
9646
9647 Defaults to @samp{100}.
9648 @end deftypevr
9649
9650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
9651
9652 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
9653 @end deftypevr
9654
9655 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
9656 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
9657 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
9658 before they eat up everything.
9659 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
9660 @end deftypevr
9661
9662 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
9663 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
9664 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
9665 at all.
9666 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
9667 @end deftypevr
9668
9669 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
9670 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
9671 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
9672 processes.
9673 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
9674 @end deftypevr
9675
9676 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
9677 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
9678 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
9679 @end deftypevr
9680
9681 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
9682 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
9683 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
9684 @end deftypevr
9685
9686 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
9687 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
9688 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
9689 root.
9690 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
9691 @end deftypevr
9692
9693 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
9694 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
9695 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
9696 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
9697 instead to a different.
9698 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9699 @end deftypevr
9700
9701 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
9702 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
9703 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
9704 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
9705 CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
9706 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9707 @end deftypevr
9708
9709 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
9710 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
9711 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
9712 @end deftypevr
9713
9714 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
9715 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
9716 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
9717 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9718 @end deftypevr
9719
9720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
9721 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
9722 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
9723 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
9724 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
9725 @end deftypevr
9726
9727 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
9728 How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
9729 quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
9730 regeneration entirely.
9731 Defaults to @samp{168}.
9732 @end deftypevr
9733
9734 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
9735 SSL protocols to use.
9736 Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
9737 @end deftypevr
9738
9739 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
9740 SSL ciphers to use.
9741 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
9742 @end deftypevr
9743
9744 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
9745 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
9746 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9747 @end deftypevr
9748
9749 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
9750 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
9751 Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
9752 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9753 @end deftypevr
9754
9755 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
9756 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
9757 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
9758 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9759 @end deftypevr
9760
9761 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
9762 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
9763 bouncing the mail.
9764 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9765 @end deftypevr
9766
9767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
9768 Binary to use for sending mails.
9769 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
9770 @end deftypevr
9771
9772 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
9773 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
9774 sendmail.
9775 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9776 @end deftypevr
9777
9778 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
9779 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
9780 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
9781 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
9782 @end deftypevr
9783
9784 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
9785 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
9786 variables:
9787
9788 @table @code
9789 @item %n
9790 CRLF
9791 @item %r
9792 reason
9793 @item %s
9794 original subject
9795 @item %t
9796 recipient
9797 @end table
9798 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
9799 @end deftypevr
9800
9801 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
9802 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
9803 address.
9804 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
9805 @end deftypevr
9806
9807 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
9808 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
9809 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
9810 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
9811 X-Original-To.
9812 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9813 @end deftypevr
9814
9815 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
9816 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
9817 it?.
9818 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9819 @end deftypevr
9820
9821 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
9822 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
9823 subscribed?.
9824 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
9825 @end deftypevr
9826
9827 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
9828 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
9829 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
9830 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
9831 often.
9832 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
9833 @end deftypevr
9834
9835 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
9836 IMAP logout format string:
9837 @table @code
9838 @item %i
9839 total number of bytes read from client
9840 @item %o
9841 total number of bytes sent to client.
9842 @end table
9843 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
9844 @end deftypevr
9845
9846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
9847 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
9848 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
9849 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9850 @end deftypevr
9851
9852 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
9853 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
9854 is IDLEing.
9855 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
9856 @end deftypevr
9857
9858 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
9859 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
9860 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
9861 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
9862 support-email.
9863 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9864 @end deftypevr
9865
9866 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
9867 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
9868 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9869 @end deftypevr
9870
9871 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
9872 Workarounds for various client bugs:
9873
9874 @table @code
9875 @item delay-newmail
9876 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
9877 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
9878 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
9879 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
9880 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
9881 "Headers Only".
9882
9883 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
9884 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
9885 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
9886 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
9887
9888 @item tb-lsub-flags
9889 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
9890 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
9891 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
9892 @end table
9893 Defaults to @samp{()}.
9894 @end deftypevr
9895
9896 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
9897 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
9898 Defaults to @samp{""}.
9899 @end deftypevr
9900
9901
9902 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
9903 that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
9904 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
9905 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
9906 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
9907
9908 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
9909 and running. In that case, you can pass an
9910 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
9911 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
9912 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
9913
9914 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
9915
9916 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
9917 The dovecot package.
9918 @end deftypevr
9919
9920 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
9921 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
9922 @end deftypevr
9923
9924 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
9925 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
9926
9927 @example
9928 (dovecot-service #:config
9929 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
9930 (string "")))
9931 @end example
9932
9933 @node Web Services
9934 @subsubsection Web Services
9935
9936 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
9937
9938 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
9939 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
9940 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
9941 [#:config-file]
9942
9943 Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
9944
9945 The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
9946 Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
9947 files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
9948 arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
9949 directories are created when the service is activated.
9950
9951 @end deffn
9952
9953 @node Various Services
9954 @subsubsection Various Services
9955
9956 @cindex lirc
9957 @subsubheading Lirc Service
9958
9959 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
9960
9961 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
9962 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
9963 [#:extra-options '()]
9964 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
9965 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
9966
9967 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
9968 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
9969 for details.
9970
9971 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
9972 passed to @command{lircd}.
9973 @end deffn
9974
9975 @cindex spice
9976 @subsubheading Spice Service
9977
9978 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
9979
9980 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
9981 Returns a service that runs @url{http://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
9982 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
9983 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
9984 @end deffn
9985
9986 @subsubsection Dictionary Services
9987 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
9988
9989 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
9990 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
9991 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
9992
9993 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
9994 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
9995 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
9996
9997 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
9998 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
9999 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10000 @end deffn
10001
10002 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
10003 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
10004
10005 @table @asis
10006 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
10007 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
10008
10009 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
10010 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
10011 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
10012 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10013
10014 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
10015 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
10016 @end table
10017 @end deftp
10018
10019 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
10020 Data type representing a dictionary database.
10021
10022 @table @asis
10023 @item @code{name}
10024 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
10025
10026 @item @code{module}
10027 Name of the dicod module used by this database
10028 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10029
10030 @item @code{options}
10031 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
10032 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
10033 @end table
10034 @end deftp
10035
10036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
10037 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
10038 Dictonary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
10039 @end defvr
10040
10041 @node Setuid Programs
10042 @subsection Setuid Programs
10043
10044 @cindex setuid programs
10045 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
10046 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
10047 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
10048 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
10049 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
10050 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
10051 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
10052 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
10053 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
10054
10055 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
10056 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
10057 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
10058 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
10059 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
10060 should be setuid root.
10061
10062 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
10063 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
10064 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10065 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
10066 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
10067
10068 @example
10069 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
10070 @end example
10071
10072 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
10073 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
10074
10075 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
10076 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
10077
10078 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
10079 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
10080 @end defvr
10081
10082 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
10083 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
10084 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
10085 store.
10086
10087 @node X.509 Certificates
10088 @subsection X.509 Certificates
10089
10090 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
10091 @cindex X.509 certificates
10092 @cindex TLS
10093 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
10094 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
10095 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
10096 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
10097 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
10098 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
10099
10100 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
10101 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
10102 out-of-the-box.
10103
10104 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
10105 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
10106 certificates can be found.
10107
10108 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
10109 In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
10110 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
10111 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
10112 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
10113 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
10114
10115 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
10116 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
10117 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
10118 to the certificates installed globally.
10119
10120 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
10121 can also install their own certificate package in
10122 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
10123 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
10124 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
10125 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
10126 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
10127 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
10128 would typically run something like:
10129
10130 @example
10131 $ guix package -i nss-certs
10132 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
10133 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
10134 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
10135 @end example
10136
10137 @node Name Service Switch
10138 @subsection Name Service Switch
10139
10140 @cindex name service switch
10141 @cindex NSS
10142 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
10143 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
10144 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10145 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
10146 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
10147 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
10148 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
10149 C Library Reference Manual}).
10150
10151 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
10152 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
10153 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
10154 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
10155 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
10156 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
10157
10158 @cindex nss-mdns
10159 @cindex .local, host name lookup
10160 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
10161 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
10162 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
10163 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
10164
10165 @example
10166 (name-service-switch
10167 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
10168
10169 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
10170 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
10171 (name-service
10172 (name "mdns_minimal")
10173
10174 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
10175 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
10176 ;; no need to try the next methods.
10177 (reaction (lookup-specification
10178 (not-found => return))))
10179
10180 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
10181 (name-service
10182 (name "dns"))
10183
10184 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
10185 (name-service
10186 (name "mdns")))))
10187 @end example
10188
10189 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
10190 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
10191 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
10192
10193 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
10194 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
10195 you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
10196 @code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
10197 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
10198 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
10199 @code{nscd-service}}).
10200
10201 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
10202 configurations.
10203
10204 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
10205 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
10206 @code{name-service-switch} object.
10207 @end defvr
10208
10209 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
10210 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
10211 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
10212 @end defvr
10213
10214 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
10215 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
10216 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
10217 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10218 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
10219 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
10220 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
10221 run @command{guix system}.
10222
10223 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
10224
10225 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
10226 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
10227 system databases.
10228
10229 @table @code
10230 @item aliases
10231 @itemx ethers
10232 @itemx group
10233 @itemx gshadow
10234 @itemx hosts
10235 @itemx initgroups
10236 @itemx netgroup
10237 @itemx networks
10238 @itemx password
10239 @itemx public-key
10240 @itemx rpc
10241 @itemx services
10242 @itemx shadow
10243 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
10244 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
10245 @end table
10246 @end deftp
10247
10248 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
10249
10250 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
10251 associated lookup action.
10252
10253 @table @code
10254 @item name
10255 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
10256 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10257
10258 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
10259 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
10260 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
10261 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
10262
10263 @item reaction
10264 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
10265 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10266 Reference Manual}). For example:
10267
10268 @example
10269 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
10270 (success => return))
10271 @end example
10272 @end table
10273 @end deftp
10274
10275 @node Initial RAM Disk
10276 @subsection Initial RAM Disk
10277
10278 @cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
10279 @cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
10280 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
10281 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
10282 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
10283 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
10284 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
10285
10286 The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
10287 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
10288 system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
10289 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
10290 @code{expression->initrd} procedure.
10291
10292 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
10293 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
10294 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
10295 system declaration like this:
10296
10297 @example
10298 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
10299 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
10300 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
10301 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
10302 (apply base-initrd file-systems
10303 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
10304 rest)))
10305 @end example
10306
10307 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
10308 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
10309 volatile root file system.
10310
10311 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
10312 options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
10313 passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
10314 @code{-append} option) of QEMU, notably:
10315
10316 @table @code
10317 @item --load=@var{boot}
10318 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
10319 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
10320
10321 GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
10322 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
10323 initialization system.
10324
10325 @item --root=@var{root}
10326 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
10327 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
10328 UUID.
10329
10330 @item --system=@var{system}
10331 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
10332 @var{system}.
10333
10334 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
10335 @cindex module, black-listing
10336 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
10337 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
10338 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
10339 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
10340 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
10341
10342 @item --repl
10343 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
10344 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
10345 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
10346 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
10347 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
10348
10349 @end table
10350
10351 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
10352 @code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
10353 further.
10354
10355 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
10356 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
10357 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
10358 Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
10359 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
10360 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
10361 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
10362 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10363
10364 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
10365 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
10366 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
10367
10368 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
10369 to it are lost.
10370
10371 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
10372 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
10373 modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
10374 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
10375 @end deffn
10376
10377 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
10378 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
10379 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
10380 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
10381 program to run in that initrd.
10382
10383 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
10384 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
10385 Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
10386 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
10387 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
10388 automatically copied to the initrd.
10389 @end deffn
10390
10391 @node GRUB Configuration
10392 @subsection GRUB Configuration
10393
10394 @cindex GRUB
10395 @cindex boot loader
10396
10397 The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
10398 (@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
10399 configured using a @code{grub-configuration} declaration. This data type
10400 is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module and described below.
10401
10402 @deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
10403 The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
10404
10405 @table @asis
10406
10407 @item @code{device}
10408 This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
10409 understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
10410 @code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
10411 GNU GRUB Manual}).
10412
10413 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
10414 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
10415 entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
10416 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
10417
10418 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
10419 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
10420 current system.
10421
10422 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
10423 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
10424 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
10425
10426 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
10427 The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
10428 @end table
10429
10430 @end deftp
10431
10432 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
10433 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
10434 @code{menu-entry} form:
10435
10436 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
10437 The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
10438
10439 @table @asis
10440
10441 @item @code{label}
10442 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
10443
10444 @item @code{linux}
10445 The Linux kernel to boot.
10446
10447 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
10448 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
10449 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10450
10451 @item @code{initrd}
10452 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
10453 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
10454
10455 @end table
10456 @end deftp
10457
10458 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
10459 Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
10460 documented yet.
10461
10462 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
10463 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
10464 fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
10465 @end defvr
10466
10467
10468 @node Invoking guix system
10469 @subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
10470
10471 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
10472 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
10473 system} command. The synopsis is:
10474
10475 @example
10476 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
10477 @end example
10478
10479 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
10480 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
10481 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
10482 supported:
10483
10484 @table @code
10485 @item reconfigure
10486 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
10487 switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
10488 running GuixSD.}.
10489
10490 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
10491 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
10492 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
10493 currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
10494 attempt to upgrade it since this would not be possible without stopping it
10495 first.
10496
10497 It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
10498 entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
10499 @option{--no-grub} is passed.
10500
10501 @quotation Note
10502 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
10503 @c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
10504 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
10505 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
10506 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
10507 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
10508 @end quotation
10509
10510 @item build
10511 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
10512 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
10513 This action does not actually install anything.
10514
10515 @item init
10516 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
10517 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
10518 installations of GuixSD. For instance:
10519
10520 @example
10521 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
10522 @end example
10523
10524 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
10525 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
10526 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
10527 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
10528 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
10529
10530 This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
10531 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
10532
10533 @item vm
10534 @cindex virtual machine
10535 @cindex VM
10536 @anchor{guix system vm}
10537 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
10538 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
10539 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU.
10540
10541 The VM shares its store with the host system.
10542
10543 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
10544 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
10545 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
10546 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
10547
10548 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
10549 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
10550 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
10551
10552 @example
10553 guix system vm my-config.scm \
10554 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
10555 @end example
10556
10557 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
10558 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
10559 store of the host can then be mounted.
10560
10561 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
10562 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
10563 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
10564 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
10565 size of the image.
10566
10567 @item vm-image
10568 @itemx disk-image
10569 Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
10570 in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
10571 to specify the size of the image.
10572
10573 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
10574 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
10575 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
10576
10577 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
10578 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
10579 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
10580 using the following command:
10581
10582 @example
10583 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
10584 @end example
10585
10586 @item container
10587 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
10588 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
10589 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
10590 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
10591 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
10592 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
10593
10594 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
10595 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
10596 system.
10597
10598 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
10599 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
10600 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
10601
10602 @example
10603 guix system container my-config.scm \
10604 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
10605 @end example
10606
10607 @quotation Note
10608 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
10609 @end quotation
10610
10611 @end table
10612
10613 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
10614 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
10615 following:
10616
10617 @table @option
10618 @item --system=@var{system}
10619 @itemx -s @var{system}
10620 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
10621 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
10622
10623 @item --derivation
10624 @itemx -d
10625 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
10626 building anything.
10627
10628 @item --image-size=@var{size}
10629 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
10630 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
10631 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
10632 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
10633
10634 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
10635 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
10636 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
10637
10638 @table @code
10639 @item nothing-special
10640 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
10641
10642 @item backtrace
10643 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
10644
10645 @item debug
10646 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
10647 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
10648 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
10649 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
10650 a list of available debugging commands.
10651 @end table
10652 @end table
10653
10654 @quotation Note
10655 All the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
10656 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
10657 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
10658 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
10659 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
10660 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
10661 @end quotation
10662
10663 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
10664 your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
10665 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
10666 GRUB boot menu:
10667
10668 @table @code
10669
10670 @item list-generations
10671 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
10672 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
10673 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
10674 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
10675
10676 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
10677 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
10678 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
10679 generations that are up to 10 days old:
10680
10681 @example
10682 $ guix system list-generations 10d
10683 @end example
10684
10685 @end table
10686
10687 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
10688 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
10689 each other:
10690
10691 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
10692 @table @code
10693
10694 @item extension-graph
10695 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
10696 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
10697 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
10698 extensions.)
10699
10700 The command:
10701
10702 @example
10703 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
10704 @end example
10705
10706 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
10707
10708 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
10709 @item shepherd-graph
10710 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
10711 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
10712 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
10713 example graph.
10714
10715 @end table
10716
10717 @node Running GuixSD in a VM
10718 @subsection Running GuixSD in a Virtual Machine
10719
10720 One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
10721 virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
10722 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
10723 which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
10724
10725 To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
10726 and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
10727 you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
10728 platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
10729 of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
10730
10731 @example
10732 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
10733 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
10734 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
10735 @end example
10736
10737 Here is what each of these options means:
10738
10739 @table @code
10740 @item qemu-system-x86_64
10741 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
10742 host.
10743
10744 @item -net user
10745 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
10746 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
10747 guest OS online. If you do not choose a network stack, the boot will
10748 fail.
10749
10750 @item -net nic,model=virtio
10751 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
10752 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
10753 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
10754 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
10755
10756 @item -enable-kvm
10757 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
10758 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
10759 faster.
10760
10761 @item -m 256
10762 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
10763 which may be insufficient for some operations.
10764
10765 @item /tmp/qemu-image
10766 The file name of the qcow2 image.
10767 @end table
10768
10769 @node Defining Services
10770 @subsection Defining Services
10771
10772 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
10773 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
10774 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
10775
10776 @menu
10777 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
10778 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
10779 * Service Reference:: API reference.
10780 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
10781 @end menu
10782
10783 @node Service Composition
10784 @subsubsection Service Composition
10785
10786 @cindex services
10787 @cindex daemons
10788 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
10789 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
10790 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
10791 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
10792 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
10793 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
10794 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
10795 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
10796 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
10797 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
10798 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
10799 of the system.
10800
10801 @cindex service extensions
10802 GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
10803 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the GuixSD
10804 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
10805 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
10806 Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
10807 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
10808 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
10809 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
10810 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
10811 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
10812 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
10813
10814 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
10815 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
10816 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
10817
10818 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
10819
10820 @cindex system service
10821 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
10822 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
10823 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
10824 to learn about the other service types shown here.
10825 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
10826 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
10827 particular operating system definition.
10828
10829 @cindex service types
10830 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
10831 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
10832 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
10833 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
10834 different parameters.
10835
10836 The following section describes the programming interface for service
10837 types and services.
10838
10839 @node Service Types and Services
10840 @subsubsection Service Types and Services
10841
10842 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
10843 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
10844 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
10845
10846 @example
10847 (define guix-service-type
10848 (service-type
10849 (name 'guix)
10850 (extensions
10851 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
10852 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
10853 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
10854 @end example
10855
10856 @noindent
10857 It defines two things:
10858
10859 @enumerate
10860 @item
10861 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
10862
10863 @item
10864 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
10865 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
10866 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
10867
10868 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
10869 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
10870 @end enumerate
10871
10872 In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
10873
10874 @table @var
10875 @item shepherd-root-service-type
10876 The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
10877 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
10878 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
10879 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
10880
10881 @item account-service-type
10882 This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
10883 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
10884 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
10885 guix-daemon}).
10886
10887 @item activation-service-type
10888 Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
10889 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
10890 booted.
10891 @end table
10892
10893 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
10894
10895 @example
10896 (service guix-service-type
10897 (guix-configuration
10898 (build-accounts 5)
10899 (use-substitutes? #f)))
10900 @end example
10901
10902 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
10903 the parameters of this specific service instance.
10904 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
10905 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
10906
10907 @var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
10908 services but is not extensible itself.
10909
10910 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
10911
10912 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
10913
10914 @example
10915 (define udev-service-type
10916 (service-type (name 'udev)
10917 (extensions
10918 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
10919 udev-shepherd-service)))
10920
10921 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
10922 (extend (lambda (config rules)
10923 (match config
10924 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
10925 (udev-configuration
10926 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
10927 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
10928 @end example
10929
10930 This is the service type for the
10931 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
10932 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
10933 extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
10934
10935 @table @code
10936 @item compose
10937 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
10938 services of this type.
10939
10940 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
10941 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
10942
10943 @item extend
10944 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
10945 the composition of the extensions.
10946
10947 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
10948 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
10949 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
10950 list of contributed rules.
10951 @end table
10952
10953 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
10954 @var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
10955 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
10956
10957 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
10958 interface for services.
10959
10960 @node Service Reference
10961 @subsubsection Service Reference
10962
10963 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
10964 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
10965 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
10966 @code{(gnu services)} module.
10967
10968 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
10969 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
10970 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
10971 this particular service instance.
10972 @end deffn
10973
10974 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
10975 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
10976 @end deffn
10977
10978 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
10979 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
10980 @end deffn
10981
10982 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
10983 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
10984 parameters.
10985 @end deffn
10986
10987 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
10988
10989 @example
10990 (define s
10991 (service nginx-service-type
10992 (nginx-configuration
10993 (nginx nginx)
10994 (log-directory log-directory)
10995 (run-directory run-directory)
10996 (file config-file))))
10997
10998 (service? s)
10999 @result{} #t
11000
11001 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
11002 @result{} #t
11003 @end example
11004
11005 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
11006 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
11007 @var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
11008 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
11009 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
11010 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
11011 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
11012 common pattern.
11013
11014 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
11015 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
11016
11017 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
11018 clauses. Each clause has the form:
11019
11020 @example
11021 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
11022 @end example
11023
11024 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
11025 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
11026 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
11027 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
11028 @var{type}.
11029
11030 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
11031 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
11032 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
11033 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
11034 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
11035 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
11036
11037 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
11038
11039 @end deffn
11040
11041 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
11042 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
11043 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
11044 @code{operating-system} declaration.
11045
11046 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
11047 @cindex service type
11048 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
11049 and Services}).
11050
11051 @table @asis
11052 @item @code{name}
11053 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
11054
11055 @item @code{extensions}
11056 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
11057
11058 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
11059 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
11060 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
11061 services.
11062
11063 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
11064 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
11065 extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
11066 the service instance.
11067
11068 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
11069 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
11070
11071 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
11072 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first argument
11073 and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
11074 second argument.
11075 @end table
11076
11077 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
11078 @end deftp
11079
11080 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
11081 @var{compute}
11082 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
11083 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
11084 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
11085 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
11086 @end deffn
11087
11088 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
11089 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
11090 @end deffn
11091
11092 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
11093 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
11094 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
11095 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
11096 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
11097 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
11098 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
11099
11100 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
11101 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
11102 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
11103 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
11104 @end deffn
11105
11106 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
11107 service types, some of which are listed below.
11108
11109 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
11110 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
11111 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
11112 @end defvr
11113
11114 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
11115 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
11116 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
11117 @end defvr
11118
11119 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
11120 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
11121 passing it name/file tuples such as:
11122
11123 @example
11124 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
11125 @end example
11126
11127 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
11128 pointing to the given file.
11129 @end defvr
11130
11131 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
11132 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
11133 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
11134 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
11135 @end defvr
11136
11137 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
11138 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
11139 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
11140 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
11141 @end defvr
11142
11143
11144 @node Shepherd Services
11145 @subsubsection Shepherd Services
11146
11147 @cindex PID 1
11148 @cindex init system
11149 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
11150 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the GuixSD
11151 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
11152 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
11153 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
11154
11155 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
11156 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
11157 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
11158 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
11159 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
11160
11161 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
11162
11163 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
11164 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
11165 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
11166
11167 The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
11168 PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
11169 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
11170
11171 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
11172 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
11173
11174 @table @asis
11175 @item @code{provision}
11176 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
11177
11178 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
11179 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
11180 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
11181 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
11182
11183 @item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
11184 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
11185
11186 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
11187 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
11188 underlying process dies.
11189
11190 @item @code{start}
11191 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
11192 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
11193 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
11194 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
11195 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
11196 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11197
11198 @item @code{documentation}
11199 A documentation string, as shown when running:
11200
11201 @example
11202 herd doc @var{service-name}
11203 @end example
11204
11205 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
11206 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
11207
11208 @item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
11209 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
11210 @code{stop} are evaluated.
11211
11212 @end table
11213 @end deftp
11214
11215 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
11216 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
11217
11218 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
11219 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
11220 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
11221 @end defvr
11222
11223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
11224 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
11225 @end defvr
11226
11227
11228 @node Installing Debugging Files
11229 @section Installing Debugging Files
11230
11231 @cindex debugging files
11232 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
11233 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
11234 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
11235 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
11236 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
11237
11238 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
11239 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
11240 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
11241 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
11242 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
11243 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
11244 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
11245
11246 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
11247 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
11248 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
11249 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
11250 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
11251 with GDB}).
11252
11253 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
11254 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
11255 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
11256 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
11257 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
11258 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
11259 Guile:
11260
11261 @example
11262 guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
11263 @end example
11264
11265 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
11266 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
11267 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
11268 GDB}):
11269
11270 @example
11271 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
11272 @end example
11273
11274 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
11275 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
11276
11277 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
11278 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
11279 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
11280 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
11281 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
11282 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
11283
11284 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
11285 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
11286 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
11287 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
11288 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
11289 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
11290 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
11291 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
11292
11293
11294 @node Security Updates
11295 @section Security Updates
11296
11297 @cindex security updates
11298 @cindex security vulnerabilities
11299 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
11300 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
11301 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
11302 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
11303 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
11304 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
11305 distribution:
11306
11307 @smallexample
11308 $ guix lint -c cve
11309 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc-2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
11310 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc-4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
11311 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg-2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
11312 @dots{}
11313 @end smallexample
11314
11315 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
11316
11317 @quotation Note
11318 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
11319 ``beta''.
11320 @end quotation
11321
11322 Guix follows a functional
11323 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
11324 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
11325 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
11326 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
11327 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
11328 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
11329 desired.
11330
11331 @cindex grafts
11332 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
11333 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
11334 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
11335 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
11336 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
11337 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
11338 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
11339
11340 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
11341 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
11342 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
11343 Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
11344 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
11345 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
11346
11347 @example
11348 (define bash
11349 (package
11350 (name "bash")
11351 ;; @dots{}
11352 (replacement bash-fixed)))
11353 @end example
11354
11355 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
11356 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
11357 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
11358 @var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
11359 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
11360 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
11361 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
11362 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
11363
11364 Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
11365 @var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
11366 and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
11367 that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
11368 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
11369 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
11370 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
11371
11372 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
11373 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
11374 Thus, the command:
11375
11376 @example
11377 guix build bash --no-grafts
11378 @end example
11379
11380 @noindent
11381 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
11382
11383 @example
11384 guix build bash
11385 @end example
11386
11387 @noindent
11388 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
11389 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
11390
11391 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
11392 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
11393
11394 @example
11395 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
11396 @end example
11397
11398 @noindent
11399 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
11400 Likewise for a complete GuixSD system generation:
11401
11402 @example
11403 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
11404 @end example
11405
11406 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
11407 @command{lsof} command:
11408
11409 @example
11410 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
11411 @end example
11412
11413
11414 @node Package Modules
11415 @section Package Modules
11416
11417 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
11418 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
11419 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
11420 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
11421 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
11422 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
11423 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
11424 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
11425 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
11426 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
11427 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
11428
11429 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
11430 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
11431 instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
11432 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
11433 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
11434 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
11435
11436 @cindex customization, of packages
11437 @cindex package module search path
11438 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
11439 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
11440 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
11441 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
11442 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
11443 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
11444 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
11445 will not be visible by default. Users can invoke commands such as
11446 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} with the
11447 @code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
11448 yet, they can use the
11449 @code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
11450 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
11451 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
11452 variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
11453 honored by all the user interfaces.
11454
11455 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
11456 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
11457 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
11458 over the own modules of the distribution.
11459 @end defvr
11460
11461 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
11462 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
11463 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
11464 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
11465 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
11466 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
11467
11468 @node Packaging Guidelines
11469 @section Packaging Guidelines
11470
11471 The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
11472 packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
11473 grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
11474 help.
11475
11476 Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
11477 @dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
11478 all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
11479 essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
11480 build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
11481 it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
11482 description and licensing information.
11483
11484 In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
11485 Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
11486 written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
11487 for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
11488 and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
11489 However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
11490 creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
11491 @pxref{Defining Packages}.
11492
11493 Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
11494 source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
11495 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
11496 called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
11497 (@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
11498
11499 @example
11500 ./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
11501 @end example
11502
11503 Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
11504 it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
11505 command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
11506 build log.
11507
11508 If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
11509 the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
11510 clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
11511 the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
11512
11513 @example
11514 ./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
11515 @end example
11516
11517 Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
11518 (@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
11519 help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
11520 new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
11521 @url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
11522 system}.
11523
11524 @cindex substituter
11525 Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
11526 @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
11527 @code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
11528 package automatically downloads binaries from there
11529 (@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
11530 needed is to review and apply the patch.
11531
11532
11533 @menu
11534 * Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
11535 * Package Naming:: What's in a name?
11536 * Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
11537 * Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
11538 * Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
11539 * Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
11540 * Java Packages:: Coffee break.
11541 * Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
11542 @end menu
11543
11544 @node Software Freedom
11545 @subsection Software Freedom
11546
11547 @c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
11548
11549 The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
11550 freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
11551 users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
11552 essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
11553 in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
11554 modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
11555 software that conveys these four freedoms.
11556
11557 In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
11558 @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
11559 software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
11560 reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
11561 discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
11562
11563 Some otherwise free upstream package sources contain a small and optional
11564 subset that violates the above guidelines, for instance because this subset
11565 is itself non-free code. When that happens, the offending items are removed
11566 with appropriate patches or code snippets in the @code{origin} form of the
11567 package (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This way, @code{guix
11568 build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
11569 upstream source.
11570
11571
11572 @node Package Naming
11573 @subsection Package Naming
11574
11575 A package has actually two names associated with it:
11576 First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
11577 @code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
11578 Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
11579 the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
11580 is used by package management commands such as
11581 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
11582
11583 Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
11584 the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
11585 hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
11586 SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
11587
11588 We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
11589 already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
11590 Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
11591 the Python and Perl languages.
11592
11593 Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
11594
11595
11596 @node Version Numbers
11597 @subsection Version Numbers
11598
11599 We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
11600 project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
11601 two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
11602 different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
11603 in @ref{Package Naming}
11604 for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
11605 by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
11606 distinguish the two versions.
11607
11608 The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
11609 package and does not contain any version number.
11610
11611 For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
11612
11613 @example
11614 (define-public gtk+
11615 (package
11616 (name "gtk+")
11617 (version "3.9.12")
11618 ...))
11619 (define-public gtk+-2
11620 (package
11621 (name "gtk+")
11622 (version "2.24.20")
11623 ...))
11624 @end example
11625 If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
11626 @example
11627 (define-public gtk+-3.8
11628 (package
11629 (name "gtk+")
11630 (version "3.8.2")
11631 ...))
11632 @end example
11633
11634 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
11635 @c for a discussion of what follows.
11636 @cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
11637 Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
11638 (VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
11639 because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
11640 release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
11641 the @code{version} field?
11642
11643 Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
11644 visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
11645 version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
11646 --upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
11647 identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
11648 a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
11649 snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
11650
11651 @example
11652 2.0.11-3.cabba9e
11653 ^ ^ ^
11654 | | `-- upstream commit ID
11655 | |
11656 | `--- Guix package revision
11657 |
11658 latest upstream version
11659 @end example
11660
11661 It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
11662 field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
11663 aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
11664 limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
11665 kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
11666 @code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities. A typical package
11667 definition may look like this:
11668
11669 @example
11670 (define my-package
11671 (let ((commit "c3f29bc928d5900971f65965feaae59e1272a3f7")
11672 (revision "1")) ;Guix package revision
11673 (package
11674 (version (string-append "0.9-" revision "."
11675 (string-take commit 7)))
11676 (source (origin
11677 (method git-fetch)
11678 (uri (git-reference
11679 (url "git://example.org/my-package.git")
11680 (commit commit)))
11681 (sha256 (base32 "1mbikn@dots{}"))
11682 (file-name (string-append "my-package-" version
11683 "-checkout"))))
11684 ;; @dots{}
11685 )))
11686 @end example
11687
11688 @node Synopses and Descriptions
11689 @subsection Synopses and Descriptions
11690
11691 As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
11692 synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
11693 descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
11694 --search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
11695 determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
11696 packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
11697
11698 Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
11699 period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
11700 not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
11701 tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
11702 is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
11703 used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
11704 matching a pattern''.
11705
11706 Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
11707 audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
11708 might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
11709 fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
11710 is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
11711 application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
11712 something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
11713 hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
11714 looking for.
11715
11716 Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
11717 sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
11718 Please avoid marketing phrases such as ``world-leading'',
11719 ``industrial-strength'', and ``next-generation'', and avoid superlatives
11720 like ``the most advanced''---they are not helpful to users looking for a
11721 package and may even sound suspicious. Instead, try to be factual,
11722 mentioning use cases and features.
11723
11724 @cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
11725 Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
11726 ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
11727 hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
11728 should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
11729 curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
11730 (@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
11731 such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
11732 appropriately.
11733
11734 Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
11735 @uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
11736 Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
11737 their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
11738 the language specified by the current locale.
11739
11740 Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
11741 attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
11742 additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
11743 to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
11744 special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
11745 Gettext}):
11746
11747 @example
11748 ;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
11749 (description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
11750 for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
11751 @end example
11752
11753
11754 @node Python Modules
11755 @subsection Python Modules
11756
11757 We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
11758 @code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
11759 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
11760 seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
11761 the word @code{python}.
11762
11763 Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
11764 If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
11765 @code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
11766 @code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
11767 packages with the corresponding names.
11768
11769 If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
11770 for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
11771 @code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}. If the project name
11772 starts with @code{py} (e.g. @code{pytz}), we keep it and prefix it as
11773 described above.
11774
11775
11776 @node Perl Modules
11777 @subsection Perl Modules
11778
11779 Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
11780 using the lowercase upstream name.
11781 For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
11782 replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
11783 @code{perl-}.
11784 So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
11785 Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
11786 are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
11787 @code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
11788 prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
11789
11790
11791 @node Java Packages
11792 @subsection Java Packages
11793
11794 Java programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
11795 using the lowercase upstream name.
11796
11797 To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages,
11798 it is desirable that the name of a package for a Java package is
11799 prefixed with @code{java-}. If a project already contains the word
11800 @code{java}, we drop this; for instance, the package @code{ngsjava} is
11801 packaged under the name @code{java-ngs}.
11802
11803 For Java packages containing a single class or a small class hierarchy,
11804 we use the lowercase class name, replace all occurrences of @code{.} by
11805 dashes and prepend the prefix @code{java-}. So the class
11806 @code{apache.commons.cli} becomes package
11807 @code{java-apache-commons-cli}.
11808
11809
11810 @node Fonts
11811 @subsection Fonts
11812
11813 For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
11814 purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
11815 we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
11816 applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
11817 are part of TeX Live.
11818
11819 To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
11820 containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
11821 upstream package name.
11822
11823 The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
11824 @code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
11825 if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
11826 replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
11827 to lower case).
11828 For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
11829 @code{font-sil-gentium}.
11830
11831 For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
11832 is used in the place of the font family name.
11833 For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
11834 Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
11835 These could be packaged separately under the names
11836 @code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
11837 under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
11838 @code{font-liberation}.
11839
11840 In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
11841 are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
11842 is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
11843 @code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
11844 fonts.
11845
11846
11847
11848 @node Bootstrapping
11849 @section Bootstrapping
11850
11851 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
11852
11853 @cindex bootstrapping
11854
11855 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
11856 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
11857 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
11858 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
11859 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
11860 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
11861 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
11862 a ``regular user''.
11863
11864 @cindex bootstrap binaries
11865 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
11866 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
11867 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
11868 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
11869 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
11870 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
11871 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
11872 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
11873 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
11874
11875 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
11876 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
11877
11878 @unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
11879
11880 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
11881 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
11882 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
11883
11884 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
11885 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
11886 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
11887 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
11888
11889 @example
11890 guix graph -t derivation \
11891 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
11892 | dot -Tps > t.ps
11893 @end example
11894
11895 At this level of detail, things are
11896 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
11897 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
11898 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
11899 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
11900 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
11901 (@pxref{The Store}).
11902
11903 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
11904 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
11905 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
11906 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
11907 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
11908 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
11909 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
11910 tarball to be unpacked.
11911
11912 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
11913 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
11914 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
11915 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
11916 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
11917 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
11918 in the store, using the original layout. The
11919 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
11920 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
11921 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
11922 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
11923
11924 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
11925 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
11926 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
11927
11928
11929 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
11930
11931 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
11932 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
11933 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
11934 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
11935 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
11936 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
11937 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
11938
11939 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
11940 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
11941 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
11942 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
11943 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
11944 package from source. The command:
11945
11946 @example
11947 guix graph -t bag \
11948 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
11949 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
11950 @end example
11951
11952 @noindent
11953 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
11954 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
11955 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
11956 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
11957
11958 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
11959
11960 @c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
11961 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
11962 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
11963 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
11964 built.
11965
11966 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
11967 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
11968 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
11969 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
11970
11971 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
11972 GCC uses @code{ld}
11973 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
11974 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
11975 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
11976
11977 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
11978 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
11979 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
11980 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
11981 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
11982
11983
11984 @unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
11985
11986 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
11987 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
11988 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
11989 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
11990
11991 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
11992 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
11993 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
11994
11995 @example
11996 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
11997 @end example
11998
11999 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
12000 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
12001 this section.
12002
12003 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
12004 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
12005 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
12006 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
12007 know.
12008
12009 @node Porting
12010 @section Porting to a New Platform
12011
12012 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
12013 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
12014 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
12015 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
12016 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
12017 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
12018 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
12019
12020 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
12021 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
12022 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
12023 one:
12024
12025 @example
12026 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
12027 @end example
12028
12029 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
12030 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
12031 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
12032 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
12033 taught about the new platform.
12034
12035 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
12036 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
12037 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
12038 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
12039 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
12040 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules do download it for
12041 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
12042 as well.
12043
12044 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
12045 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
12046 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
12047 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
12048 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
12049 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
12050 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
12051 reason.
12052
12053 @c *********************************************************************
12054 @include contributing.texi
12055
12056 @c *********************************************************************
12057 @node Acknowledgments
12058 @chapter Acknowledgments
12059
12060 Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
12061 which was designed and
12062 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
12063 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
12064 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
12065 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
12066 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
12067
12068 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
12069 an inspiration for Guix.
12070
12071 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
12072 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
12073 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
12074 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
12075 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
12076
12077
12078 @c *********************************************************************
12079 @node GNU Free Documentation License
12080 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
12081
12082 @include fdl-1.3.texi
12083
12084 @c *********************************************************************
12085 @node Concept Index
12086 @unnumbered Concept Index
12087 @printindex cp
12088
12089 @node Programming Index
12090 @unnumbered Programming Index
12091 @syncodeindex tp fn
12092 @syncodeindex vr fn
12093 @printindex fn
12094
12095 @bye
12096
12097 @c Local Variables:
12098 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
12099 @c End: